OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/open8_urisc/open8_urisc/trunk

Subversion Repositories open8_urisc

[/] [open8_urisc/] [trunk/] [gnu/] [binutils/] [bfd/] [elf.c] - Blame information for rev 163

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 14 khays
/* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
 
3
   Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
4
   2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
5
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
 
7
   This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8
 
9
   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10
   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11
   the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12
   (at your option) any later version.
13
 
14
   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15
   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16
   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
17
   GNU General Public License for more details.
18
 
19
   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20
   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
21
   Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
22
   MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
23
 
24
 
25
/*
26
SECTION
27
        ELF backends
28
 
29
        BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
30
        Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
31
        (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
32
 
33
        Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
34
        to be written.  The code is changing quickly enough that we
35
        haven't bothered yet.  */
36
 
37
/* For sparc64-cross-sparc32.  */
38
#define _SYSCALL32
39
#include "sysdep.h"
40
#include "bfd.h"
41
#include "bfdlink.h"
42
#include "libbfd.h"
43
#define ARCH_SIZE 0
44
#include "elf-bfd.h"
45
#include "libiberty.h"
46
#include "safe-ctype.h"
47
 
48
#ifdef CORE_HEADER
49
#include CORE_HEADER
50
#endif
51
 
52
static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53
static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
54
static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
55
static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct bfd_strtab_hash **, int) ;
56
static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
57
static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58
                                    file_ptr offset);
59
 
60
/* Swap version information in and out.  The version information is
61
   currently size independent.  If that ever changes, this code will
62
   need to move into elfcode.h.  */
63
 
64
/* Swap in a Verdef structure.  */
65
 
66
void
67
_bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68
                         const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69
                         Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
70
{
71
  dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72
  dst->vd_flags   = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73
  dst->vd_ndx     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74
  dst->vd_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75
  dst->vd_hash    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76
  dst->vd_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77
  dst->vd_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
78
}
79
 
80
/* Swap out a Verdef structure.  */
81
 
82
void
83
_bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84
                          const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85
                          Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
86
{
87
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
94
}
95
 
96
/* Swap in a Verdaux structure.  */
97
 
98
void
99
_bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100
                          const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101
                          Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
102
{
103
  dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104
  dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
105
}
106
 
107
/* Swap out a Verdaux structure.  */
108
 
109
void
110
_bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111
                           const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112
                           Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
113
{
114
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
116
}
117
 
118
/* Swap in a Verneed structure.  */
119
 
120
void
121
_bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122
                          const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123
                          Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
124
{
125
  dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126
  dst->vn_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127
  dst->vn_file    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128
  dst->vn_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129
  dst->vn_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
130
}
131
 
132
/* Swap out a Verneed structure.  */
133
 
134
void
135
_bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136
                           const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137
                           Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
138
{
139
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
144
}
145
 
146
/* Swap in a Vernaux structure.  */
147
 
148
void
149
_bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150
                          const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151
                          Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
152
{
153
  dst->vna_hash  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154
  dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155
  dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156
  dst->vna_name  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157
  dst->vna_next  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
158
}
159
 
160
/* Swap out a Vernaux structure.  */
161
 
162
void
163
_bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164
                           const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165
                           Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
166
{
167
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
172
}
173
 
174
/* Swap in a Versym structure.  */
175
 
176
void
177
_bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178
                         const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179
                         Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
180
{
181
  dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
182
}
183
 
184
/* Swap out a Versym structure.  */
185
 
186
void
187
_bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188
                          const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189
                          Elf_External_Versym *dst)
190
{
191
  H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
192
}
193
 
194
/* Standard ELF hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
195
   cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
196
 
197
unsigned long
198
bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
199
{
200
  const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
201
  unsigned long h = 0;
202
  unsigned long g;
203
  int ch;
204
 
205
  while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
206
    {
207
      h = (h << 4) + ch;
208
      if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
209
        {
210
          h ^= g >> 24;
211
          /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212
             this case and on some machines one insn instead of two.  */
213
          h ^= g;
214
        }
215
    }
216
  return h & 0xffffffff;
217
}
218
 
219
/* DT_GNU_HASH hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
220
   cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
221
 
222
unsigned long
223
bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
224
{
225
  const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226
  unsigned long h = 5381;
227
  unsigned char ch;
228
 
229
  while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230
    h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231
  return h & 0xffffffff;
232
}
233
 
234
/* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235
   the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID.  */
236
bfd_boolean
237
bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
238
                         size_t object_size,
239
                         enum elf_target_id object_id)
240
{
241
  BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242
  abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243
  if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
244
    return FALSE;
245
 
246
  elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247
  elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
248
  return TRUE;
249
}
250
 
251
 
252
bfd_boolean
253
bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
254
{
255
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
256
  return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
257
                                  bed->target_id);
258
}
259
 
260
bfd_boolean
261
bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
262
{
263
  /* I think this can be done just like an object file.  */
264
  return abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd);
265
}
266
 
267
static char *
268
bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
269
{
270
  Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
271
  bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
272
  file_ptr offset;
273
  bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
274
 
275
  i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
276
  if (i_shdrp == 0
277
      || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
278
      || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
279
    return NULL;
280
 
281
  shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
282
  if (shstrtab == NULL)
283
    {
284
      /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read.  */
285
      offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
286
      shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
287
 
288
      /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
289
         in case the string table is not terminated.  */
290
      if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
291
          || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL
292
          || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
293
        shstrtab = NULL;
294
      else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
295
        {
296
          if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
297
            bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
298
          shstrtab = NULL;
299
          /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
300
             trying.  Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
301
             the string table over and over.  */
302
          i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
303
        }
304
      else
305
        shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
306
      i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
307
    }
308
  return (char *) shstrtab;
309
}
310
 
311
char *
312
bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
313
                                 unsigned int shindex,
314
                                 unsigned int strindex)
315
{
316
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
317
 
318
  if (strindex == 0)
319
    return "";
320
 
321
  if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
322
    return NULL;
323
 
324
  hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
325
 
326
  if (hdr->contents == NULL
327
      && bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
328
    return NULL;
329
 
330
  if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
331
    {
332
      unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
333
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
334
        (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
335
         abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
336
         (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
337
          ? ".shstrtab"
338
          : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
339
      return NULL;
340
    }
341
 
342
  return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
343
}
344
 
345
/* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
346
   SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
347
   symbol SYMOFFSET.  If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
348
   are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
349
   symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
350
   Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
351
   or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem.  */
352
 
353
Elf_Internal_Sym *
354
bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
355
                      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
356
                      size_t symcount,
357
                      size_t symoffset,
358
                      Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
359
                      void *extsym_buf,
360
                      Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
361
{
362
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
363
  void *alloc_ext;
364
  const bfd_byte *esym;
365
  Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
366
  Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
367
  Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
368
  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
369
  Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
370
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
371
  size_t extsym_size;
372
  bfd_size_type amt;
373
  file_ptr pos;
374
 
375
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
376
    abort ();
377
 
378
  if (symcount == 0)
379
    return intsym_buf;
380
 
381
  /* Normal syms might have section extension entries.  */
382
  shndx_hdr = NULL;
383
  if (symtab_hdr == &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_hdr)
384
    shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
385
 
386
  /* Read the symbols.  */
387
  alloc_ext = NULL;
388
  alloc_extshndx = NULL;
389
  alloc_intsym = NULL;
390
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
391
  extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
392
  amt = symcount * extsym_size;
393
  pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
394
  if (extsym_buf == NULL)
395
    {
396
      alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
397
      extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
398
    }
399
  if (extsym_buf == NULL
400
      || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
401
      || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
402
    {
403
      intsym_buf = NULL;
404
      goto out;
405
    }
406
 
407
  if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
408
    extshndx_buf = NULL;
409
  else
410
    {
411
      amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
412
      pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
413
      if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
414
        {
415
          alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
416
              bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
417
          extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
418
        }
419
      if (extshndx_buf == NULL
420
          || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
421
          || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
422
        {
423
          intsym_buf = NULL;
424
          goto out;
425
        }
426
    }
427
 
428
  if (intsym_buf == NULL)
429
    {
430
      alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
431
          bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
432
      intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
433
      if (intsym_buf == NULL)
434
        goto out;
435
    }
436
 
437
  /* Convert the symbols to internal form.  */
438
  isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
439
  for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
440
           shndx = extshndx_buf;
441
       isym < isymend;
442
       esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
443
    if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
444
      {
445
        symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
446
        (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
447
                                 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
448
                               ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
449
        if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
450
          free (alloc_intsym);
451
        intsym_buf = NULL;
452
        goto out;
453
      }
454
 
455
 out:
456
  if (alloc_ext != NULL)
457
    free (alloc_ext);
458
  if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
459
    free (alloc_extshndx);
460
 
461
  return intsym_buf;
462
}
463
 
464
/* Look up a symbol name.  */
465
const char *
466
bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
467
                  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
468
                  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
469
                  asection *sym_sec)
470
{
471
  const char *name;
472
  unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
473
  unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
474
 
475
  if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
476
      /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing.  */
477
      && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
478
    {
479
      iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
480
      shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
481
    }
482
 
483
  name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
484
  if (name == NULL)
485
    name = "(null)";
486
  else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
487
    name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
488
 
489
  return name;
490
}
491
 
492
/* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
493
   sections.  The first element is the flags, the rest are section
494
   pointers.  */
495
 
496
typedef union elf_internal_group {
497
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
498
  unsigned int flags;
499
} Elf_Internal_Group;
500
 
501
/* Return the name of the group signature symbol.  Why isn't the
502
   signature just a string?  */
503
 
504
static const char *
505
group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
506
{
507
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
508
  unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
509
  Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
510
  Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
511
 
512
  /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available.  Make sure
513
     that it is a symbol table section.  */
514
  if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
515
    return NULL;
516
  hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
517
  if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
518
      || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
519
    return NULL;
520
 
521
  /* Go read the symbol.  */
522
  hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
523
  if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
524
                            &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
525
    return NULL;
526
 
527
  return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
528
}
529
 
530
/* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT.  */
531
 
532
static bfd_boolean
533
setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
534
{
535
  unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
536
 
537
  /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections.  The count
538
     is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections.  */
539
  if (num_group == 0)
540
    {
541
      unsigned int i, shnum;
542
 
543
      /* First count the number of groups.  If we have a SHT_GROUP
544
         section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it.  */
545
      shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
546
      num_group = 0;
547
 
548
#define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr)             \
549
        (   (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP                \
550
         && (shdr)->sh_size >= (2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE)     \
551
         && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE        \
552
         && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
553
 
554
      for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
555
        {
556
          Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
557
 
558
          if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
559
            num_group += 1;
560
        }
561
 
562
      if (num_group == 0)
563
        {
564
          num_group = (unsigned) -1;
565
          elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
566
        }
567
      else
568
        {
569
          /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
570
             so we can find them quickly.  */
571
          bfd_size_type amt;
572
 
573
          elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
574
          elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
575
              bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
576
          if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
577
            return FALSE;
578
 
579
          num_group = 0;
580
          for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
581
            {
582
              Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
583
 
584
              if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
585
                {
586
                  unsigned char *src;
587
                  Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
588
 
589
                  /* Add to list of sections.  */
590
                  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
591
                  num_group += 1;
592
 
593
                  /* Read the raw contents.  */
594
                  BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
595
                  amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
596
                  shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
597
                      bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
598
                  /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers.  */
599
                  if (shdr->contents == NULL)
600
                    {
601
                      _bfd_error_handler
602
                        (_("%B: Corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
603
                      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
604
                      return FALSE;
605
                    }
606
 
607
                  memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
608
 
609
                  if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
610
                      || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
611
                          != shdr->sh_size))
612
                    return FALSE;
613
 
614
                  /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
615
                     array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
616
                     to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
617
                     pointers.  */
618
                  src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
619
                  dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
620
                  while (1)
621
                    {
622
                      unsigned int idx;
623
 
624
                      src -= 4;
625
                      --dest;
626
                      idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
627
                      if (src == shdr->contents)
628
                        {
629
                          dest->flags = idx;
630
                          if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
631
                            shdr->bfd_section->flags
632
                              |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
633
                          break;
634
                        }
635
                      if (idx >= shnum)
636
                        {
637
                          ((*_bfd_error_handler)
638
                           (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
639
                          idx = 0;
640
                        }
641
                      dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
642
                    }
643
                }
644
            }
645
        }
646
    }
647
 
648
  if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
649
    {
650
      unsigned int i;
651
 
652
      for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
653
        {
654
          Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
655
          Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
656
          unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
657
 
658
          /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
659
             section is a member.  */
660
          while (--n_elt != 0)
661
            if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
662
              {
663
                asection *s = NULL;
664
 
665
                /* We are a member of this group.  Go looking through
666
                   other members to see if any others are linked via
667
                   next_in_group.  */
668
                idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
669
                n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
670
                while (--n_elt != 0)
671
                  if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
672
                      && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
673
                    break;
674
                if (n_elt != 0)
675
                  {
676
                    /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
677
                       insert current section in circular list.  */
678
                    elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
679
                    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
680
                    elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
681
                  }
682
                else
683
                  {
684
                    const char *gname;
685
 
686
                    gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
687
                    if (gname == NULL)
688
                      return FALSE;
689
                    elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
690
 
691
                    /* Start a circular list with one element.  */
692
                    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
693
                  }
694
 
695
                /* If the group section has been created, point to the
696
                   new member.  */
697
                if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
698
                  elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
699
 
700
                i = num_group - 1;
701
                break;
702
              }
703
        }
704
    }
705
 
706
  if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
707
    {
708
      (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
709
                             abfd, newsect);
710
    }
711
  return TRUE;
712
}
713
 
714
bfd_boolean
715
_bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
716
{
717
  unsigned int i;
718
  unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
719
  bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
720
  asection *s;
721
 
722
  /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
723
  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
724
    {
725
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
726
      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
727
        {
728
          unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
729
          /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
730
             not set the sh_link or sh_info fields.  Hence we could
731
             get the situation where elfsec is 0.  */
732
          if (elfsec == 0)
733
            {
734
              const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
735
              if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
736
                bed->link_order_error_handler
737
                  (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
738
                   abfd, s);
739
            }
740
          else
741
            {
742
              asection *linksec = NULL;
743
 
744
              if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
745
                {
746
                  this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
747
                  linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
748
                }
749
 
750
              /* PR 1991, 2008:
751
                 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
752
                 sh_link.  We don't want to proceed.  */
753
              if (linksec == NULL)
754
                {
755
                  (*_bfd_error_handler)
756
                    (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
757
                     s->owner, s, elfsec);
758
                  result = FALSE;
759
                }
760
 
761
              elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
762
            }
763
        }
764
    }
765
 
766
  /* Process section groups.  */
767
  if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
768
    return result;
769
 
770
  for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
771
    {
772
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
773
      Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
774
      unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
775
 
776
      while (--n_elt != 0)
777
        if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
778
          elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
779
        else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
780
                 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
781
          /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
782
             output object files. We adjust the group section size here
783
             so that relocatable link will work correctly when
784
             relocation sections are in section group in input object
785
             files.  */
786
          shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
787
        else
788
          {
789
            /* There are some unknown sections in the group.  */
790
            (*_bfd_error_handler)
791
              (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
792
               abfd,
793
               (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
794
               bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
795
                                                (elf_elfheader (abfd)
796
                                                 ->e_shstrndx),
797
                                                idx->shdr->sh_name),
798
               shdr->bfd_section->name);
799
            result = FALSE;
800
          }
801
    }
802
  return result;
803
}
804
 
805
bfd_boolean
806
bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
807
{
808
  return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
809
}
810
 
811
/* Make a BFD section from an ELF section.  We store a pointer to the
812
   BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header.  */
813
 
814
bfd_boolean
815
_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
816
                                 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
817
                                 const char *name,
818
                                 int shindex)
819
{
820
  asection *newsect;
821
  flagword flags;
822
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
823
 
824
  if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
825
    return TRUE;
826
 
827
  newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
828
  if (newsect == NULL)
829
    return FALSE;
830
 
831
  hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
832
  elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
833
  elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
834
 
835
  /* Always use the real type/flags.  */
836
  elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
837
  elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
838
 
839
  newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
840
 
841
  if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
842
      || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
843
      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
844
                                      bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
845
    return FALSE;
846
 
847
  flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
848
  if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
849
    flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
850
  if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
851
    flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
852
  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
853
    {
854
      flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
855
      if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
856
        flags |= SEC_LOAD;
857
    }
858
  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
859
    flags |= SEC_READONLY;
860
  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
861
    flags |= SEC_CODE;
862
  else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
863
    flags |= SEC_DATA;
864
  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
865
    {
866
      flags |= SEC_MERGE;
867
      newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
868
      if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
869
        flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
870
    }
871
  if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
872
    if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
873
      return FALSE;
874
  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
875
    flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
876
  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
877
    flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
878
 
879
  if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
880
    {
881
      /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
882
         not any sort of flag.  Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared.  */
883
      static const struct
884
        {
885
          const char *name;
886
          int len;
887
        } debug_sections [] =
888
        {
889
          { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("debug") },       /* 'd' */
890
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'e' */
891
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'f' */
892
          { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("gnu.linkonce.wi.") },    /* 'g' */
893
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'h' */
894
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'i' */
895
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'j' */
896
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'k' */
897
          { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("line") },        /* 'l' */
898
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'm' */
899
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'n' */
900
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'o' */
901
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'p' */
902
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'q' */
903
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'r' */
904
          { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("stab") },        /* 's' */
905
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 't' */
906
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'u' */
907
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'v' */
908
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'w' */
909
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'x' */
910
          { NULL,                0  },   /* 'y' */
911
          { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("zdebug") }       /* 'z' */
912
        };
913
 
914
      if (name [0] == '.')
915
        {
916
          int i = name [1] - 'd';
917
          if (i >= 0
918
              && i < (int) ARRAY_SIZE (debug_sections)
919
              && debug_sections [i].name != NULL
920
              && strncmp (&name [1], debug_sections [i].name,
921
                          debug_sections [i].len) == 0)
922
            flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
923
        }
924
    }
925
 
926
  /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
927
     only link a single copy of the section.  This is used to support
928
     g++.  g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
929
     The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
930
     are permitted.  The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
931
     all but one of the sections.  */
932
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
933
      && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
934
    flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
935
 
936
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
937
  if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
938
    if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
939
      return FALSE;
940
 
941
  if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
942
    return FALSE;
943
 
944
  /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
945
     separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
946
     PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD.  */
947
  if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
948
    {
949
      bfd_byte *contents;
950
 
951
      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
952
        return FALSE;
953
 
954
      elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
955
      free (contents);
956
    }
957
 
958
  if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
959
    {
960
      Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
961
      unsigned int i, nload;
962
 
963
      /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
964
         p_paddr fields zero.  If we have such a binary with more than
965
         one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
966
         so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma.  */
967
      phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
968
      for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
969
        if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
970
          break;
971
        else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
972
          ++nload;
973
      if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
974
        return TRUE;
975
 
976
      phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
977
      for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
978
        {
979
          if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
980
                && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
981
               || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
982
              && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
983
            {
984
              if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
985
                newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
986
                                + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
987
              else
988
                /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
989
                   sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
990
                   is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
991
                   Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
992
                   the segment LMA.  It is assumed that the
993
                   segment will contain sections with contiguous
994
                   LMAs, even if the VMAs are not.  */
995
                newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
996
                                + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
997
 
998
              /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
999
                 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1000
                 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1001
                 beginning of the next.  Decide based on vaddr.  */
1002
              if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1003
                  && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1004
                      <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1005
                break;
1006
            }
1007
        }
1008
    }
1009
 
1010
  /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1011
     .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set.  */
1012
  if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1013
      && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1014
          || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1015
    {
1016
      enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1017
      char *new_name;
1018
 
1019
      if (bfd_is_section_compressed (abfd, newsect))
1020
        {
1021
          /* Compressed section.  Check if we should decompress.  */
1022
          if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1023
            action = decompress;
1024
        }
1025
      else
1026
        {
1027
          /* Normal section.  Check if we should compress.  */
1028
          if ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS))
1029
            action = compress;
1030
        }
1031
 
1032
      new_name = NULL;
1033
      switch (action)
1034
        {
1035
        case nothing:
1036
          break;
1037
        case compress:
1038
          if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1039
            {
1040
              (*_bfd_error_handler)
1041
                (_("%B: unable to initialize commpress status for section %s"),
1042
                 abfd, name);
1043
              return FALSE;
1044
            }
1045
          if (name[1] != 'z')
1046
            {
1047
              unsigned int len = strlen (name);
1048
 
1049
              new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
1050
              if (new_name == NULL)
1051
                return FALSE;
1052
              new_name[0] = '.';
1053
              new_name[1] = 'z';
1054
              memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
1055
            }
1056
          break;
1057
        case decompress:
1058
          if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1059
            {
1060
              (*_bfd_error_handler)
1061
                (_("%B: unable to initialize decommpress status for section %s"),
1062
                 abfd, name);
1063
              return FALSE;
1064
            }
1065
          if (name[1] == 'z')
1066
            {
1067
              unsigned int len = strlen (name);
1068
 
1069
              new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
1070
              if (new_name == NULL)
1071
                return FALSE;
1072
              new_name[0] = '.';
1073
              memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
1074
            }
1075
          break;
1076
        }
1077
      if (new_name != NULL)
1078
        bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1079
    }
1080
 
1081
  return TRUE;
1082
}
1083
 
1084
const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
1085
  "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1086
  "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1087
  "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1088
};
1089
 
1090
/* ELF relocs are against symbols.  If we are producing relocatable
1091
   output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1092
   has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1093
   be against the same symbol.  In such a case, we don't want to
1094
   change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1095
   all be done at final link time.  Rather than put special case code
1096
   into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1097
   function.  It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1098
   relocatable output against an external symbol.  */
1099
 
1100
bfd_reloc_status_type
1101
bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1102
                       arelent *reloc_entry,
1103
                       asymbol *symbol,
1104
                       void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1105
                       asection *input_section,
1106
                       bfd *output_bfd,
1107
                       char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1108
{
1109
  if (output_bfd != NULL
1110
      && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1111
      && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1112
          || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1113
    {
1114
      reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1115
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1116
    }
1117
 
1118
  return bfd_reloc_continue;
1119
}
1120
 
1121
/* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1122
   another.  */
1123
 
1124
bfd_boolean
1125
_bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1126
{
1127
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1128
      || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1129
    return TRUE;
1130
 
1131
  BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (obfd)
1132
              || (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
1133
                  == elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags));
1134
 
1135
  elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1136
  elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1137
  elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1138
 
1139
  /* Copy object attributes.  */
1140
  _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1141
  return TRUE;
1142
}
1143
 
1144
static const char *
1145
get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1146
{
1147
  const char *pt;
1148
  switch (p_type)
1149
    {
1150
    case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1151
    case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1152
    case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1153
    case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1154
    case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1155
    case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1156
    case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1157
    case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1158
    case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1159
    case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1160
    case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1161
    default: pt = NULL; break;
1162
    }
1163
  return pt;
1164
}
1165
 
1166
/* Print out the program headers.  */
1167
 
1168
bfd_boolean
1169
_bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1170
{
1171
  FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1172
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1173
  asection *s;
1174
  bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1175
 
1176
  p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1177
  if (p != NULL)
1178
    {
1179
      unsigned int i, c;
1180
 
1181
      fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1182
      c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1183
      for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1184
        {
1185
          const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1186
          char buf[20];
1187
 
1188
          if (pt == NULL)
1189
            {
1190
              sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1191
              pt = buf;
1192
            }
1193
          fprintf (f, "%8s off    0x", pt);
1194
          bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1195
          fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1196
          bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1197
          fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1198
          bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1199
          fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1200
          fprintf (f, "         filesz 0x");
1201
          bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1202
          fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1203
          bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1204
          fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1205
                   (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1206
                   (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1207
                   (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1208
          if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1209
            fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1210
          fprintf (f, "\n");
1211
        }
1212
    }
1213
 
1214
  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1215
  if (s != NULL)
1216
    {
1217
      unsigned int elfsec;
1218
      unsigned long shlink;
1219
      bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1220
      size_t extdynsize;
1221
      void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1222
 
1223
      fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1224
 
1225
      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1226
        goto error_return;
1227
 
1228
      elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1229
      if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1230
        goto error_return;
1231
      shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1232
 
1233
      extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1234
      swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1235
 
1236
      extdyn = dynbuf;
1237
      extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1238
      for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1239
        {
1240
          Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1241
          const char *name = "";
1242
          char ab[20];
1243
          bfd_boolean stringp;
1244
          const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1245
 
1246
          (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1247
 
1248
          if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1249
            break;
1250
 
1251
          stringp = FALSE;
1252
          switch (dyn.d_tag)
1253
            {
1254
            default:
1255
              if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1256
                name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1257
 
1258
              if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1259
                {
1260
                  sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1261
                  name = ab;
1262
                }
1263
              break;
1264
 
1265
            case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1266
            case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1267
            case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1268
            case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1269
            case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1270
            case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1271
            case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1272
            case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1273
            case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1274
            case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1275
            case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1276
            case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1277
            case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1278
            case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1279
            case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1280
            case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1281
            case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1282
            case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1283
            case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1284
            case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1285
            case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1286
            case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1287
            case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1288
            case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1289
            case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1290
            case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1291
            case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1292
            case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1293
            case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1294
            case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1295
            case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1296
            case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1297
            case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1298
            case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1299
            case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1300
            case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1301
            case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1302
            case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1303
            case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1304
            case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1305
            case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1306
            case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1307
            case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1308
            case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1309
            case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1310
            case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1311
            case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1312
            case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1313
            case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1314
            case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1315
            case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1316
            case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1317
            case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1318
            case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1319
            case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1320
            case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1321
            case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1322
            case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1323
            }
1324
 
1325
          fprintf (f, "  %-20s ", name);
1326
          if (! stringp)
1327
            {
1328
              fprintf (f, "0x");
1329
              bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1330
            }
1331
          else
1332
            {
1333
              const char *string;
1334
              unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1335
 
1336
              string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1337
              if (string == NULL)
1338
                goto error_return;
1339
              fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1340
            }
1341
          fprintf (f, "\n");
1342
        }
1343
 
1344
      free (dynbuf);
1345
      dynbuf = NULL;
1346
    }
1347
 
1348
  if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1349
      || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1350
    {
1351
      if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1352
        return FALSE;
1353
    }
1354
 
1355
  if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1356
    {
1357
      Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1358
 
1359
      fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1360
      for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1361
        {
1362
          fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1363
                   t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1364
                   t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1365
          if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1366
            {
1367
              Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1368
 
1369
              fprintf (f, "\t");
1370
              for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1371
                   a != NULL;
1372
                   a = a->vda_nextptr)
1373
                fprintf (f, "%s ",
1374
                         a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1375
              fprintf (f, "\n");
1376
            }
1377
        }
1378
    }
1379
 
1380
  if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1381
    {
1382
      Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1383
 
1384
      fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1385
      for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1386
        {
1387
          Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1388
 
1389
          fprintf (f, _("  required from %s:\n"),
1390
                   t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1391
          for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1392
            fprintf (f, "    0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1393
                     a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1394
                     a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1395
        }
1396
    }
1397
 
1398
  return TRUE;
1399
 
1400
 error_return:
1401
  if (dynbuf != NULL)
1402
    free (dynbuf);
1403
  return FALSE;
1404
}
1405
 
1406
/* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol.  */
1407
 
1408
void
1409
bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1410
                      void *filep,
1411
                      asymbol *symbol,
1412
                      bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1413
{
1414
  FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1415
  switch (how)
1416
    {
1417
    case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1418
      fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1419
      break;
1420
    case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1421
      fprintf (file, "elf ");
1422
      bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1423
      fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
1424
      break;
1425
    case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1426
      {
1427
        const char *section_name;
1428
        const char *name = NULL;
1429
        const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1430
        unsigned char st_other;
1431
        bfd_vma val;
1432
 
1433
        section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1434
 
1435
        bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1436
        if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1437
          name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1438
 
1439
        if (name == NULL)
1440
          {
1441
            name = symbol->name;
1442
            bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1443
          }
1444
 
1445
        fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1446
        /* Print the "other" value for a symbol.  For common symbols,
1447
           we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1448
           For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1449
           we've printed the address; now print the size.  */
1450
        if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1451
          val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1452
        else
1453
          val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1454
        bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1455
 
1456
        /* If we have version information, print it.  */
1457
        if (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_section != 0
1458
            && (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_section != 0
1459
                || elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_section != 0))
1460
          {
1461
            unsigned int vernum;
1462
            const char *version_string;
1463
 
1464
            vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_VERSION;
1465
 
1466
            if (vernum == 0)
1467
              version_string = "";
1468
            else if (vernum == 1)
1469
              version_string = "Base";
1470
            else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1471
              version_string =
1472
                elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1473
            else
1474
              {
1475
                Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1476
 
1477
                version_string = "";
1478
                for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1479
                     t != NULL;
1480
                     t = t->vn_nextref)
1481
                  {
1482
                    Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1483
 
1484
                    for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1485
                      {
1486
                        if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1487
                          {
1488
                            version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1489
                            break;
1490
                          }
1491
                      }
1492
                  }
1493
              }
1494
 
1495
            if ((((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_HIDDEN) == 0)
1496
              fprintf (file, "  %-11s", version_string);
1497
            else
1498
              {
1499
                int i;
1500
 
1501
                fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1502
                for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1503
                  putc (' ', file);
1504
              }
1505
          }
1506
 
1507
        /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it.  */
1508
        st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1509
 
1510
        switch (st_other)
1511
          {
1512
          case 0: break;
1513
          case STV_INTERNAL:  fprintf (file, " .internal");  break;
1514
          case STV_HIDDEN:    fprintf (file, " .hidden");    break;
1515
          case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1516
          default:
1517
            /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1518
               everything hex.  */
1519
            fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1520
          }
1521
 
1522
        fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1523
      }
1524
      break;
1525
    }
1526
}
1527
 
1528
/* Allocate an ELF string table--force the first byte to be zero.  */
1529
 
1530
struct bfd_strtab_hash *
1531
_bfd_elf_stringtab_init (void)
1532
{
1533
  struct bfd_strtab_hash *ret;
1534
 
1535
  ret = _bfd_stringtab_init ();
1536
  if (ret != NULL)
1537
    {
1538
      bfd_size_type loc;
1539
 
1540
      loc = _bfd_stringtab_add (ret, "", TRUE, FALSE);
1541
      BFD_ASSERT (loc == 0 || loc == (bfd_size_type) -1);
1542
      if (loc == (bfd_size_type) -1)
1543
        {
1544
          _bfd_stringtab_free (ret);
1545
          ret = NULL;
1546
        }
1547
    }
1548
  return ret;
1549
}
1550
 
1551
/* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1552
 
1553
/* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header.  */
1554
 
1555
bfd_boolean
1556
bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1557
{
1558
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1559
  Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1560
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1561
  const char *name;
1562
 
1563
  if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1564
    return FALSE;
1565
 
1566
  hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1567
  ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1568
  name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
1569
                                          hdr->sh_name);
1570
  if (name == NULL)
1571
    return FALSE;
1572
 
1573
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1574
  switch (hdr->sh_type)
1575
    {
1576
    case SHT_NULL:
1577
      /* Inactive section. Throw it away.  */
1578
      return TRUE;
1579
 
1580
    case SHT_PROGBITS:  /* Normal section with contents.  */
1581
    case SHT_NOBITS:    /* .bss section.  */
1582
    case SHT_HASH:      /* .hash section.  */
1583
    case SHT_NOTE:      /* .note section.  */
1584
    case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:        /* .init_array section.  */
1585
    case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:        /* .fini_array section.  */
1586
    case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:     /* .preinit_array section.  */
1587
    case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:       /* .gnu.liblist section.  */
1588
    case SHT_GNU_HASH:          /* .gnu.hash section.  */
1589
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1590
 
1591
    case SHT_DYNAMIC:   /* Dynamic linking information.  */
1592
      if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1593
        return FALSE;
1594
      if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
1595
        {
1596
          /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
1597
             field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER.  */
1598
          switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
1599
            {
1600
            case bfd_arch_i386:
1601
            case bfd_arch_sparc:
1602
              if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
1603
                  || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
1604
                break;
1605
              /* Otherwise fall through.  */
1606
            default:
1607
              return FALSE;
1608
            }
1609
        }
1610
      else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
1611
        return FALSE;
1612
      else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
1613
        {
1614
          Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
1615
 
1616
          /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
1617
             sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section.  Find the
1618
             string table for the ".dynsym" section instead.  */
1619
          if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1620
            {
1621
              dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
1622
              hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1623
            }
1624
          else
1625
            {
1626
              unsigned int i, num_sec;
1627
 
1628
              num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1629
              for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1630
                {
1631
                  dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1632
                  if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1633
                    {
1634
                      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1635
                      break;
1636
                    }
1637
                }
1638
            }
1639
        }
1640
      break;
1641
 
1642
    case SHT_SYMTAB:            /* A symbol table */
1643
      if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1644
        return TRUE;
1645
 
1646
      if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1647
        return FALSE;
1648
      if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1649
        return FALSE;
1650
      BFD_ASSERT (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0);
1651
      elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1652
      elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr = *hdr;
1653
      elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1654
      abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1655
 
1656
      /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table.  If
1657
         SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
1658
         treat this section as a BFD section.  We can not base the
1659
         decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
1660
         set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
1661
         linker.  */
1662
      if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
1663
          && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
1664
          && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1665
                                                shindex))
1666
        return FALSE;
1667
 
1668
      /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
1669
         can't read symbols without that section loaded as well.  It
1670
         is most likely specified by the next section header.  */
1671
      if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]->sh_link != shindex)
1672
        {
1673
          unsigned int i, num_sec;
1674
 
1675
          num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1676
          for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1677
            {
1678
              Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1679
              if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1680
                  && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1681
                break;
1682
            }
1683
          if (i == num_sec)
1684
            for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
1685
              {
1686
                Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1687
                if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1688
                    && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1689
                  break;
1690
              }
1691
          if (i != shindex)
1692
            return bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
1693
        }
1694
      return TRUE;
1695
 
1696
    case SHT_DYNSYM:            /* A dynamic symbol table */
1697
      if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1698
        return TRUE;
1699
 
1700
      if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1701
        return FALSE;
1702
      BFD_ASSERT (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0);
1703
      elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1704
      elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
1705
      elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
1706
      abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1707
 
1708
      /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
1709
         section, so that objcopy can handle it.  */
1710
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1711
 
1712
    case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX:      /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections */
1713
      if (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == shindex)
1714
        return TRUE;
1715
 
1716
      BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == 0);
1717
      elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = shindex;
1718
      elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr = *hdr;
1719
      elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
1720
      return TRUE;
1721
 
1722
    case SHT_STRTAB:            /* A string table */
1723
      if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1724
        return TRUE;
1725
      if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
1726
        {
1727
          elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1728
          elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
1729
          return TRUE;
1730
        }
1731
      if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1732
        {
1733
        symtab_strtab:
1734
          elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
1735
          elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
1736
          return TRUE;
1737
        }
1738
      if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1739
        {
1740
        dynsymtab_strtab:
1741
          elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1742
          hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
1743
          elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
1744
          /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
1745
             can handle it.  */
1746
          return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1747
                                                  shindex);
1748
        }
1749
 
1750
      /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
1751
         regular section.  We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
1752
         just in case this strtab section appeared before the above.  */
1753
      if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
1754
        {
1755
          unsigned int i, num_sec;
1756
 
1757
          num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1758
          for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1759
            {
1760
              Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1761
              if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1762
                {
1763
                  /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects.  */
1764
                  if (i == shindex)
1765
                    return FALSE;
1766
                  if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
1767
                    return FALSE;
1768
                  if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
1769
                    goto symtab_strtab;
1770
                  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
1771
                    goto dynsymtab_strtab;
1772
                }
1773
            }
1774
        }
1775
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1776
 
1777
    case SHT_REL:
1778
    case SHT_RELA:
1779
      /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections!  */
1780
      {
1781
        asection *target_sect;
1782
        Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
1783
        unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1784
        struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
1785
        bfd_size_type amt;
1786
 
1787
        if (hdr->sh_entsize
1788
            != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
1789
                                ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
1790
          return FALSE;
1791
 
1792
        /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing.  */
1793
        if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
1794
          {
1795
            ((*_bfd_error_handler)
1796
             (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
1797
              abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
1798
            return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1799
                                                    shindex);
1800
          }
1801
 
1802
        /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
1803
           libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
1804
           bogus sh_link fields.  It would be nice if we could just
1805
           reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
1806
           them.  We scan through the section headers; if we find only
1807
           one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
1808
           to it.  I hope this doesn't break anything.
1809
 
1810
           Don't do it on executable nor shared library.  */
1811
        if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
1812
            && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
1813
            && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
1814
          {
1815
            unsigned int scan;
1816
            int found;
1817
 
1818
            found = 0;
1819
            for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
1820
              {
1821
                if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1822
                    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1823
                  {
1824
                    if (found != 0)
1825
                      {
1826
                        found = 0;
1827
                        break;
1828
                      }
1829
                    found = scan;
1830
                  }
1831
              }
1832
            if (found != 0)
1833
              hdr->sh_link = found;
1834
          }
1835
 
1836
        /* Get the symbol table.  */
1837
        if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1838
             || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1839
            && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
1840
          return FALSE;
1841
 
1842
        /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
1843
           don't treat it as a reloc section.  BFD can't adequately
1844
           represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
1845
           try.  We just present it as a normal section.  We also
1846
           can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
1847
           section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
1848
           sh_link points to the null section.  */
1849
        if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
1850
            || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
1851
            || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
1852
            || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
1853
            || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
1854
            || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1855
          return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1856
                                                  shindex);
1857
 
1858
        if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
1859
          return FALSE;
1860
        target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
1861
        if (target_sect == NULL)
1862
          return FALSE;
1863
 
1864
        esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
1865
        if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1866
          p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
1867
        else
1868
          p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
1869
 
1870
        BFD_ASSERT (*p_hdr == NULL);
1871
        amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
1872
        hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
1873
        if (hdr2 == NULL)
1874
          return FALSE;
1875
        *hdr2 = *hdr;
1876
        *p_hdr = hdr2;
1877
        elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
1878
        target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
1879
        target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
1880
        target_sect->relocation = NULL;
1881
        target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1882
        /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
1883
           its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety.  */
1884
        if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1885
          {
1886
            if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1887
              target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
1888
          }
1889
        abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
1890
        return TRUE;
1891
      }
1892
 
1893
    case SHT_GNU_verdef:
1894
      elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
1895
      elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
1896
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1897
 
1898
    case SHT_GNU_versym:
1899
      if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
1900
        return FALSE;
1901
      elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
1902
      elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
1903
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1904
 
1905
    case SHT_GNU_verneed:
1906
      elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
1907
      elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
1908
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1909
 
1910
    case SHT_SHLIB:
1911
      return TRUE;
1912
 
1913
    case SHT_GROUP:
1914
      if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr))
1915
        return FALSE;
1916
      if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1917
        return FALSE;
1918
      if (hdr->contents != NULL)
1919
        {
1920
          Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
1921
          unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
1922
          asection *s;
1923
 
1924
          if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
1925
            hdr->bfd_section->flags
1926
              |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1927
 
1928
          /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in.  */
1929
          idx += n_elt;
1930
          while (--n_elt != 0)
1931
            {
1932
              --idx;
1933
 
1934
              if (idx->shdr != NULL
1935
                  && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
1936
                  && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
1937
                {
1938
                  elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
1939
                  break;
1940
                }
1941
            }
1942
        }
1943
      break;
1944
 
1945
    default:
1946
      /* Possibly an attributes section.  */
1947
      if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
1948
          || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
1949
        {
1950
          if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1951
            return FALSE;
1952
          _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
1953
          return TRUE;
1954
        }
1955
 
1956
      /* Check for any processor-specific section types.  */
1957
      if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1958
        return TRUE;
1959
 
1960
      if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
1961
        {
1962
          if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1963
            /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
1964
               for applications?  */
1965
            (*_bfd_error_handler)
1966
              (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
1967
                 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
1968
               abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1969
          else
1970
            /* Allow sections reserved for applications.  */
1971
            return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1972
                                                    shindex);
1973
        }
1974
      else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
1975
               && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
1976
        /* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
1977
        (*_bfd_error_handler)
1978
          (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
1979
             "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
1980
           abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1981
      else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
1982
        {
1983
          /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections.  */
1984
          if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
1985
            /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
1986
               required to correctly process the section and the file should
1987
               be rejected with an error message.  */
1988
            (*_bfd_error_handler)
1989
              (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
1990
                 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
1991
               abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1992
          else
1993
            /* Otherwise it should be processed.  */
1994
            return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1995
        }
1996
      else
1997
        /* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
1998
        (*_bfd_error_handler)
1999
          (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2000
           abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2001
 
2002
      return FALSE;
2003
    }
2004
 
2005
  return TRUE;
2006
}
2007
 
2008
/* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX.  */
2009
 
2010
Elf_Internal_Sym *
2011
bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2012
                       bfd *abfd,
2013
                       unsigned long r_symndx)
2014
{
2015
  unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2016
 
2017
  if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2018
    {
2019
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2020
      unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2021
      Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2022
 
2023
      symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2024
      if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2025
                                &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2026
        return NULL;
2027
 
2028
      if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2029
        {
2030
          memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2031
          cache->abfd = abfd;
2032
        }
2033
      cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2034
    }
2035
 
2036
  return &cache->sym[ent];
2037
}
2038
 
2039
/* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2040
   section.  */
2041
 
2042
asection *
2043
bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2044
{
2045
  if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2046
    return NULL;
2047
  return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2048
}
2049
 
2050
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2051
{
2052
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2053
  { NULL,                   0,  0, 0,            0 }
2054
};
2055
 
2056
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2057
{
2058
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2059
  { NULL,                       0, 0, 0,            0 }
2060
};
2061
 
2062
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2063
{
2064
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"),         -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2065
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"),         0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2066
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"),         0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2067
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2068
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2069
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2070
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2071
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"),       0, SHT_DYNAMIC,  SHF_ALLOC },
2072
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"),        0, SHT_STRTAB,   SHF_ALLOC },
2073
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"),        0, SHT_DYNSYM,   SHF_ALLOC },
2074
  { NULL,                      0,        0, 0,            0 }
2075
};
2076
 
2077
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2078
{
2079
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"),       0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2080
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2081
  { NULL,                          0, 0, 0,              0 }
2082
};
2083
 
2084
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2085
{
2086
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2087
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"),       -1, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_EXCLUDE },
2088
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"),             0, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2089
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"),     0, SHT_GNU_versym,  0 },
2090
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"),   0, SHT_GNU_verdef,  0 },
2091
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"),   0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2092
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"),     0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2093
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"),    0, SHT_RELA,        SHF_ALLOC },
2094
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"),        0, SHT_GNU_HASH,    SHF_ALLOC },
2095
  { NULL,                        0,        0, 0,               0 }
2096
};
2097
 
2098
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2099
{
2100
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH,     SHF_ALLOC },
2101
  { NULL,                    0, 0, 0,            0 }
2102
};
2103
 
2104
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2105
{
2106
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"),       0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2107
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2108
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"),     0, SHT_PROGBITS,   0 },
2109
  { NULL,                      0,     0, 0,              0 }
2110
};
2111
 
2112
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2113
{
2114
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2115
  { NULL,                    0, 0, 0,            0 }
2116
};
2117
 
2118
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2119
{
2120
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2121
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"),          -1, SHT_NOTE,     0 },
2122
  { NULL,                    0,           0, 0,            0 }
2123
};
2124
 
2125
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2126
{
2127
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2128
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),           0, SHT_PROGBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2129
  { NULL,                   0,           0, 0,                 0 }
2130
};
2131
 
2132
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2133
{
2134
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2135
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2136
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"),   -1, SHT_RELA,     0 },
2137
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"),    -1, SHT_REL,      0 },
2138
  { NULL,                   0,     0, 0,            0 }
2139
};
2140
 
2141
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2142
{
2143
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2144
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"),   0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2145
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"),   0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2146
  /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2147
     this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix).  */
2148
  { ".stabstr",                 5,  3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2149
  { NULL,                       0,  0, 0,          0 }
2150
};
2151
 
2152
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2153
{
2154
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"),  -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2155
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"),  -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2156
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2157
  { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,            0 }
2158
};
2159
 
2160
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2161
{
2162
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2163
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2164
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2165
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2166
  { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,            0 }
2167
};
2168
 
2169
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2170
{
2171
  special_sections_b,           /* 'b' */
2172
  special_sections_c,           /* 'c' */
2173
  special_sections_d,           /* 'd' */
2174
  NULL,                         /* 'e' */
2175
  special_sections_f,           /* 'f' */
2176
  special_sections_g,           /* 'g' */
2177
  special_sections_h,           /* 'h' */
2178
  special_sections_i,           /* 'i' */
2179
  NULL,                         /* 'j' */
2180
  NULL,                         /* 'k' */
2181
  special_sections_l,           /* 'l' */
2182
  NULL,                         /* 'm' */
2183
  special_sections_n,           /* 'n' */
2184
  NULL,                         /* 'o' */
2185
  special_sections_p,           /* 'p' */
2186
  NULL,                         /* 'q' */
2187
  special_sections_r,           /* 'r' */
2188
  special_sections_s,           /* 's' */
2189
  special_sections_t,           /* 't' */
2190
  NULL,                         /* 'u' */
2191
  NULL,                         /* 'v' */
2192
  NULL,                         /* 'w' */
2193
  NULL,                         /* 'x' */
2194
  NULL,                         /* 'y' */
2195
  special_sections_z            /* 'z' */
2196
};
2197
 
2198
const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2199
_bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2200
                              const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2201
                              unsigned int rela)
2202
{
2203
  int i;
2204
  int len;
2205
 
2206
  len = strlen (name);
2207
 
2208
  for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2209
    {
2210
      int suffix_len;
2211
      int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2212
 
2213
      if (len < prefix_len)
2214
        continue;
2215
      if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2216
        continue;
2217
 
2218
      suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2219
      if (suffix_len <= 0)
2220
        {
2221
          if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2222
            {
2223
              if (suffix_len == 0)
2224
                continue;
2225
              if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2226
                  && (suffix_len == -2
2227
                      || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2228
                continue;
2229
            }
2230
        }
2231
      else
2232
        {
2233
          if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2234
            continue;
2235
          if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2236
                      spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2237
                      suffix_len) != 0)
2238
            continue;
2239
        }
2240
      return &spec[i];
2241
    }
2242
 
2243
  return NULL;
2244
}
2245
 
2246
const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2247
_bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2248
{
2249
  int i;
2250
  const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2251
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2252
 
2253
  /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
2254
  if (sec->name == NULL)
2255
    return NULL;
2256
 
2257
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2258
  spec = bed->special_sections;
2259
  if (spec)
2260
    {
2261
      spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2262
                                           bed->special_sections,
2263
                                           sec->use_rela_p);
2264
      if (spec != NULL)
2265
        return spec;
2266
    }
2267
 
2268
  if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2269
    return NULL;
2270
 
2271
  i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2272
  if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2273
    return NULL;
2274
 
2275
  spec = special_sections[i];
2276
 
2277
  if (spec == NULL)
2278
    return NULL;
2279
 
2280
  return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2281
}
2282
 
2283
bfd_boolean
2284
_bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2285
{
2286
  struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2287
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2288
  const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2289
 
2290
  sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2291
  if (sdata == NULL)
2292
    {
2293
      sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2294
                                                          sizeof (*sdata));
2295
      if (sdata == NULL)
2296
        return FALSE;
2297
      sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2298
    }
2299
 
2300
  /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations.  */
2301
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2302
  sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2303
 
2304
  /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2305
     flags.  They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2306
     anyway.  We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2307
     created sections.  If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2308
     set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2309
     elf_fake_sections.  Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2310
     output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2311
     sections.  We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2312
     copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections.  */
2313
  if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2314
      || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2315
    {
2316
      ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2317
      if (ssect != NULL
2318
          && (!sec->flags
2319
              || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2320
              || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2321
              || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2322
        {
2323
          elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2324
          elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2325
        }
2326
    }
2327
 
2328
  return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2329
}
2330
 
2331
/* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2332
 
2333
   Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2334
   of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2335
   program header table.  For segments that are split (see below) we
2336
   generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2337
 
2338
   Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2339
   (less than) the memory size.  All this means is that at execution the
2340
   system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2341
   but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2342
   file.  This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2343
   of combined data+bss.
2344
 
2345
   To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2346
   for the single program segment.  The first has the length specified by
2347
   the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2348
   by the difference between the two sizes.  In effect, the segment is split
2349
   into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2350
 
2351
 */
2352
 
2353
bfd_boolean
2354
_bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2355
                                 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2356
                                 int hdr_index,
2357
                                 const char *type_name)
2358
{
2359
  asection *newsect;
2360
  char *name;
2361
  char namebuf[64];
2362
  size_t len;
2363
  int split;
2364
 
2365
  split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2366
            && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2367
            && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2368
 
2369
  if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2370
    {
2371
      sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2372
      len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2373
      name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2374
      if (!name)
2375
        return FALSE;
2376
      memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2377
      newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2378
      if (newsect == NULL)
2379
        return FALSE;
2380
      newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2381
      newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2382
      newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2383
      newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2384
      newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2385
      newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2386
      if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2387
        {
2388
          newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2389
          newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2390
          if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2391
            {
2392
              /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2393
                 may be data.  */
2394
              newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2395
            }
2396
        }
2397
      if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2398
        {
2399
          newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2400
        }
2401
    }
2402
 
2403
  if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2404
    {
2405
      bfd_vma align;
2406
 
2407
      sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2408
      len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2409
      name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2410
      if (!name)
2411
        return FALSE;
2412
      memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2413
      newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2414
      if (newsect == NULL)
2415
        return FALSE;
2416
      newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2417
      newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2418
      newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2419
      newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2420
      align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2421
      if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2422
        align = hdr->p_align;
2423
      newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2424
      if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2425
        {
2426
          /* Hack for gdb.  Segments that have not been modified do
2427
             not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2428
             assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2429
             executable.  We flag this case by setting the fake
2430
             section size to zero.  Note that "real" bss sections will
2431
             always have their contents dumped to the core file.  */
2432
          if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2433
            newsect->size = 0;
2434
          newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2435
          if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2436
            newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2437
        }
2438
      if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2439
        newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2440
    }
2441
 
2442
  return TRUE;
2443
}
2444
 
2445
bfd_boolean
2446
bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2447
{
2448
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2449
 
2450
  switch (hdr->p_type)
2451
    {
2452
    case PT_NULL:
2453
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2454
 
2455
    case PT_LOAD:
2456
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2457
 
2458
    case PT_DYNAMIC:
2459
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2460
 
2461
    case PT_INTERP:
2462
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2463
 
2464
    case PT_NOTE:
2465
      if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2466
        return FALSE;
2467
      if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2468
        return FALSE;
2469
      return TRUE;
2470
 
2471
    case PT_SHLIB:
2472
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2473
 
2474
    case PT_PHDR:
2475
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
2476
 
2477
    case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
2478
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
2479
                                              "eh_frame_hdr");
2480
 
2481
    case PT_GNU_STACK:
2482
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
2483
 
2484
    case PT_GNU_RELRO:
2485
      return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
2486
 
2487
    default:
2488
      /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types.  */
2489
      bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2490
      return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
2491
    }
2492
}
2493
 
2494
/* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
2495
   REL or RELA.  */
2496
 
2497
Elf_Internal_Shdr *
2498
_bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
2499
{
2500
  if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
2501
    {
2502
      BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
2503
      return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
2504
    }
2505
  else
2506
    return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
2507
}
2508
 
2509
/* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
2510
   containing relocations against ASECT.  It is stored in RELDATA.  If
2511
   USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
2512
   relocations.  */
2513
 
2514
bfd_boolean
2515
_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
2516
                          struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
2517
                          asection *asect,
2518
                          bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
2519
{
2520
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
2521
  char *name;
2522
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2523
  bfd_size_type amt;
2524
 
2525
  amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
2526
  BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
2527
  rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2528
  reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
2529
 
2530
  amt = sizeof ".rela" + strlen (asect->name);
2531
  name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2532
  if (name == NULL)
2533
    return FALSE;
2534
  sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", asect->name);
2535
  rel_hdr->sh_name =
2536
    (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
2537
                                        FALSE);
2538
  if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2539
    return FALSE;
2540
  rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
2541
  rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
2542
                         ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
2543
                         : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
2544
  rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
2545
  rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
2546
  rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2547
  rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2548
  rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2549
 
2550
  return TRUE;
2551
}
2552
 
2553
/* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags.  */
2554
 
2555
int
2556
bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
2557
{
2558
  if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2559
      && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
2560
    return SHT_NOBITS;
2561
  return SHT_PROGBITS;
2562
}
2563
 
2564
struct fake_section_arg
2565
{
2566
  struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
2567
  bfd_boolean failed;
2568
};
2569
 
2570
/* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section.  */
2571
 
2572
static void
2573
elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
2574
{
2575
  struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
2576
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2577
  struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
2578
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
2579
  unsigned int sh_type;
2580
 
2581
  if (arg->failed)
2582
    {
2583
      /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
2584
         loop.  */
2585
      return;
2586
    }
2587
 
2588
  this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
2589
 
2590
  this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2591
                                                          asect->name, FALSE);
2592
  if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2593
    {
2594
      arg->failed = TRUE;
2595
      return;
2596
    }
2597
 
2598
  /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits.  */
2599
 
2600
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2601
      || asect->user_set_vma)
2602
    this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
2603
  else
2604
    this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2605
 
2606
  this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2607
  this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
2608
  this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
2609
  this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
2610
  /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
2611
     copy_private_section_data.  */
2612
 
2613
  this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
2614
  this_hdr->contents = NULL;
2615
 
2616
  /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
2617
     asect->flags.  */
2618
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
2619
    sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
2620
  else
2621
    sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
2622
 
2623
  if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
2624
    this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2625
  else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
2626
           && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
2627
           && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2628
    {
2629
      /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
2630
         allow the link to proceed.  This can happen when users link
2631
         non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
2632
         to a bss output section via a linker script.  */
2633
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
2634
        (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
2635
      this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2636
    }
2637
 
2638
  switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
2639
    {
2640
    default:
2641
      break;
2642
 
2643
    case SHT_STRTAB:
2644
    case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
2645
    case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
2646
    case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
2647
    case SHT_NOTE:
2648
    case SHT_NOBITS:
2649
    case SHT_PROGBITS:
2650
      break;
2651
 
2652
    case SHT_HASH:
2653
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
2654
      break;
2655
 
2656
    case SHT_DYNSYM:
2657
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
2658
      break;
2659
 
2660
    case SHT_DYNAMIC:
2661
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
2662
      break;
2663
 
2664
    case SHT_RELA:
2665
      if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
2666
        this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
2667
      break;
2668
 
2669
     case SHT_REL:
2670
      if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
2671
        this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
2672
      break;
2673
 
2674
     case SHT_GNU_versym:
2675
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
2676
      break;
2677
 
2678
     case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2679
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2680
      /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2681
         cverdefs.  The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
2682
         zero.  */
2683
      if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2684
        this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
2685
      else
2686
        BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
2687
                    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
2688
      break;
2689
 
2690
    case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2691
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2692
      /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2693
         cverrefs.  The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
2694
         zero.  */
2695
      if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2696
        this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
2697
      else
2698
        BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
2699
                    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
2700
      break;
2701
 
2702
    case SHT_GROUP:
2703
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
2704
      break;
2705
 
2706
    case SHT_GNU_HASH:
2707
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
2708
      break;
2709
    }
2710
 
2711
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2712
    this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
2713
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
2714
    this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
2715
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2716
    this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
2717
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
2718
    {
2719
      this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
2720
      this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
2721
      if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
2722
        this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
2723
    }
2724
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
2725
    this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
2726
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
2727
    {
2728
      this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
2729
      if (asect->size == 0
2730
          && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
2731
        {
2732
          struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
2733
 
2734
          this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2735
          if (o != NULL)
2736
            {
2737
              this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
2738
              if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
2739
                this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
2740
            }
2741
        }
2742
    }
2743
  if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
2744
    this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
2745
 
2746
  /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
2747
     SHT_REL[A] section.  If two relocation sections are required for
2748
     this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
2749
     create the other.  */
2750
  if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
2751
    {
2752
      /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
2753
         needed.  */
2754
      if (arg->link_info
2755
          /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here.  */
2756
          && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
2757
          && (arg->link_info->relocatable || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
2758
        {
2759
          if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
2760
              && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, asect, FALSE))
2761
            {
2762
              arg->failed = TRUE;
2763
              return;
2764
            }
2765
          if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
2766
              && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, asect, TRUE))
2767
            {
2768
              arg->failed = TRUE;
2769
              return;
2770
            }
2771
        }
2772
      else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
2773
                                          (asect->use_rela_p
2774
                                           ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
2775
                                          asect,
2776
                                          asect->use_rela_p))
2777
          arg->failed = TRUE;
2778
    }
2779
 
2780
  /* Check for processor-specific section types.  */
2781
  sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
2782
  if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
2783
      && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
2784
    arg->failed = TRUE;
2785
 
2786
  if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
2787
    {
2788
      /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
2789
         called for objcopy --only-keep-debug.  */
2790
      this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2791
    }
2792
}
2793
 
2794
/* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section.  Called from
2795
   _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
2796
   when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld.  Called for ld -r
2797
   from bfd_elf_final_link.  */
2798
 
2799
void
2800
bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
2801
{
2802
  bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
2803
  asection *elt, *first;
2804
  unsigned char *loc;
2805
  bfd_boolean gas;
2806
 
2807
  /* Ignore linker created group section.  See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
2808
     elfxx-ia64.c.  */
2809
  if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
2810
      || *failedptr)
2811
    return;
2812
 
2813
  if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
2814
    {
2815
      unsigned long symindx = 0;
2816
 
2817
      /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
2818
         generic linker.  */
2819
      if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
2820
        symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
2821
 
2822
      if (symindx == 0)
2823
        {
2824
          /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
2825
             elf_section_syms.  */
2826
          BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
2827
          symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
2828
        }
2829
      elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
2830
    }
2831
  else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
2832
    {
2833
      /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
2834
         signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
2835
         set until all local symbols are output.  */
2836
      asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
2837
      struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
2838
      unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
2839
      unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
2840
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2841
 
2842
      if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
2843
        {
2844
          Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2845
 
2846
          symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
2847
          extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2848
        }
2849
      h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
2850
      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2851
             || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2852
        h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2853
 
2854
      elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
2855
    }
2856
 
2857
  /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy.  */
2858
  gas = TRUE;
2859
  if (sec->contents == NULL)
2860
    {
2861
      gas = FALSE;
2862
      sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
2863
 
2864
      /* Arrange for the section to be written out.  */
2865
      elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
2866
      if (sec->contents == NULL)
2867
        {
2868
          *failedptr = TRUE;
2869
          return;
2870
        }
2871
    }
2872
 
2873
  loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
2874
 
2875
  /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
2876
     squirreled away here.  objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
2877
     start of the input section group.  */
2878
  first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
2879
 
2880
  /* First element is a flag word.  Rest of section is elf section
2881
     indices for all the sections of the group.  Write them backwards
2882
     just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
2883
     directives, not that it matters.  */
2884
  while (elt != NULL)
2885
    {
2886
      asection *s;
2887
 
2888
      s = elt;
2889
      if (!gas)
2890
        s = s->output_section;
2891
      if (s != NULL
2892
          && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
2893
        {
2894
          unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
2895
 
2896
          loc -= 4;
2897
          H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
2898
        }
2899
      elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
2900
      if (elt == first)
2901
        break;
2902
    }
2903
 
2904
  if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
2905
    abort ();
2906
 
2907
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
2908
}
2909
 
2910
/* Assign all ELF section numbers.  The dummy first section is handled here
2911
   too.  The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
2912
   in here too, while we're at it.  */
2913
 
2914
static bfd_boolean
2915
assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
2916
{
2917
  struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
2918
  asection *sec;
2919
  unsigned int section_number, secn;
2920
  Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
2921
  struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
2922
  bfd_boolean need_symtab;
2923
 
2924
  section_number = 1;
2925
 
2926
  _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
2927
 
2928
  /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only.  */
2929
  if (link_info == NULL || link_info->relocatable)
2930
    {
2931
      /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first.  */
2932
      for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2933
        {
2934
          d = elf_section_data (sec);
2935
 
2936
          if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
2937
            {
2938
              if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
2939
                {
2940
                  /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections.  */
2941
                  bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
2942
                  abfd->section_count--;
2943
                }
2944
              else
2945
                d->this_idx = section_number++;
2946
            }
2947
        }
2948
    }
2949
 
2950
  for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
2951
    {
2952
      d = elf_section_data (sec);
2953
 
2954
      if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
2955
        d->this_idx = section_number++;
2956
      _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
2957
      if (d->rel.hdr)
2958
        {
2959
          d->rel.idx = section_number++;
2960
          _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
2961
        }
2962
      else
2963
        d->rel.idx = 0;
2964
 
2965
      if (d->rela.hdr)
2966
        {
2967
          d->rela.idx = section_number++;
2968
          _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
2969
        }
2970
      else
2971
        d->rela.idx = 0;
2972
    }
2973
 
2974
  t->shstrtab_section = section_number++;
2975
  _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
2976
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = t->shstrtab_section;
2977
 
2978
  need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
2979
                || (link_info == NULL
2980
                    && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
2981
                        == HAS_RELOC)));
2982
  if (need_symtab)
2983
    {
2984
      t->symtab_section = section_number++;
2985
      _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
2986
      if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
2987
        {
2988
          t->symtab_shndx_section = section_number++;
2989
          t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name
2990
            = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2991
                                                  ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
2992
          if (t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2993
            return FALSE;
2994
        }
2995
      t->strtab_section = section_number++;
2996
      _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
2997
    }
2998
 
2999
  _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3000
  t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3001
 
3002
  elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3003
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3004
 
3005
  /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3006
     indices.  */
3007
  i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3008
                                                sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3009
  if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3010
    return FALSE;
3011
 
3012
  i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3013
                                                 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3014
  if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3015
    {
3016
      bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3017
      return FALSE;
3018
    }
3019
 
3020
  elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3021
 
3022
  i_shdrp[t->shstrtab_section] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3023
  if (need_symtab)
3024
    {
3025
      i_shdrp[t->symtab_section] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3026
      if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3027
        {
3028
          i_shdrp[t->symtab_shndx_section] = &t->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3029
          t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3030
        }
3031
      i_shdrp[t->strtab_section] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3032
      t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = t->strtab_section;
3033
    }
3034
 
3035
  for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3036
    {
3037
      asection *s;
3038
      const char *name;
3039
 
3040
      d = elf_section_data (sec);
3041
 
3042
      i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3043
      if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3044
        i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3045
      if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3046
        i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3047
 
3048
      /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it.  */
3049
 
3050
      /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3051
         table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3052
         the relocation entries apply.  */
3053
      if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3054
        {
3055
          d->rel.hdr->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3056
          d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3057
        }
3058
      if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3059
        {
3060
          d->rela.hdr->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3061
          d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3062
        }
3063
 
3064
      /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
3065
      if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3066
        {
3067
          s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3068
          if (s)
3069
            {
3070
              /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section.  */
3071
              if (link_info != NULL)
3072
                {
3073
                  /* Check discarded linkonce section.  */
3074
                  if (elf_discarded_section (s))
3075
                    {
3076
                      asection *kept;
3077
                      (*_bfd_error_handler)
3078
                        (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3079
                         abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3080
                         s, s->owner);
3081
                      /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3082
                         size as the discarded one.  */
3083
                      kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3084
                      if (kept == NULL)
3085
                        {
3086
                          bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3087
                          return FALSE;
3088
                        }
3089
                      s = kept;
3090
                    }
3091
 
3092
                  s = s->output_section;
3093
                  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3094
                }
3095
              else
3096
                {
3097
                  /* Handle objcopy. */
3098
                  if (s->output_section == NULL)
3099
                    {
3100
                      (*_bfd_error_handler)
3101
                        (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3102
                         abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3103
                      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3104
                      return FALSE;
3105
                    }
3106
                  s = s->output_section;
3107
                }
3108
              d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3109
            }
3110
          else
3111
            {
3112
              /* PR 290:
3113
                 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3114
                 SHF_LINK_ORDER.  But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3115
                 sh_info fields.  Hence we could get the situation
3116
                 where s is NULL.  */
3117
              const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3118
                = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3119
              if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3120
                bed->link_order_error_handler
3121
                  (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3122
                   abfd, sec);
3123
            }
3124
        }
3125
 
3126
      switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3127
        {
3128
        case SHT_REL:
3129
        case SHT_RELA:
3130
          /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3131
             section.  sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3132
             table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to
3133
             which the relocation entries apply.  We assume that an
3134
             allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3135
             FIXME: How can we be sure?  */
3136
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3137
          if (s != NULL)
3138
            d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3139
 
3140
          /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name.  */
3141
          name = sec->name;
3142
          if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL)
3143
            name += 4;
3144
          else
3145
            name += 5;
3146
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3147
          if (s != NULL)
3148
            d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3149
          break;
3150
 
3151
        case SHT_STRTAB:
3152
          /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3153
             string section.  We look for a section with the same name
3154
             but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3155
             field to point to this section.  */
3156
          if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3157
              && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3158
            {
3159
              size_t len;
3160
              char *alc;
3161
 
3162
              len = strlen (sec->name);
3163
              alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3164
              if (alc == NULL)
3165
                return FALSE;
3166
              memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3167
              alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3168
              s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3169
              free (alc);
3170
              if (s != NULL)
3171
                {
3172
                  elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3173
 
3174
                  /* This is a .stab section.  */
3175
                  if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3176
                    elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3177
                      = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3178
                }
3179
            }
3180
          break;
3181
 
3182
        case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3183
        case SHT_DYNSYM:
3184
        case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3185
        case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3186
          /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3187
             used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3188
             version strings.  */
3189
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3190
          if (s != NULL)
3191
            d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3192
          break;
3193
 
3194
        case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3195
          /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3196
             list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3197
             the version strings.  */
3198
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3199
                                             ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3200
          if (s != NULL)
3201
            d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3202
          break;
3203
 
3204
        case SHT_HASH:
3205
        case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3206
        case SHT_GNU_versym:
3207
          /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3208
             this hash table or version table is for.  */
3209
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3210
          if (s != NULL)
3211
            d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3212
          break;
3213
 
3214
        case SHT_GROUP:
3215
          d->this_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3216
        }
3217
    }
3218
 
3219
  for (secn = 1; secn < section_number; ++secn)
3220
    if (i_shdrp[secn] == NULL)
3221
      i_shdrp[secn] = i_shdrp[0];
3222
    else
3223
      i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3224
                                                       i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name);
3225
  return TRUE;
3226
}
3227
 
3228
/* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3229
   all local symbols to be at the head of the list.  */
3230
 
3231
static bfd_boolean
3232
sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3233
{
3234
  /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it.  */
3235
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3236
  if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3237
    return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3238
 
3239
  return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3240
          || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3241
          || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3242
}
3243
 
3244
/* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3245
   output.  */
3246
 
3247
static bfd_boolean
3248
ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3249
{
3250
  return ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3251
          && !(sym->section->owner == abfd
3252
               || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
3253
                   && sym->section->output_offset == 0)));
3254
}
3255
 
3256
static bfd_boolean
3257
elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd)
3258
{
3259
  unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3260
  asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3261
  asymbol **sect_syms;
3262
  unsigned int num_locals = 0;
3263
  unsigned int num_globals = 0;
3264
  unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
3265
  unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
3266
  int max_index = 0;
3267
  unsigned int idx;
3268
  asection *asect;
3269
  asymbol **new_syms;
3270
 
3271
#ifdef DEBUG
3272
  fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
3273
  fflush (stderr);
3274
#endif
3275
 
3276
  for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3277
    {
3278
      if (max_index < asect->index)
3279
        max_index = asect->index;
3280
    }
3281
 
3282
  max_index++;
3283
  sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
3284
  if (sect_syms == NULL)
3285
    return FALSE;
3286
  elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
3287
  elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
3288
 
3289
  /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
3290
     decided to output.  */
3291
  for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3292
    {
3293
      asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3294
 
3295
      if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3296
          && sym->value == 0
3297
          && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3298
        {
3299
          asection *sec = sym->section;
3300
 
3301
          if (sec->owner != abfd)
3302
            sec = sec->output_section;
3303
 
3304
          sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
3305
        }
3306
    }
3307
 
3308
  /* Classify all of the symbols.  */
3309
  for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3310
    {
3311
      if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
3312
        continue;
3313
      if (!sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
3314
        num_locals++;
3315
      else
3316
        num_globals++;
3317
    }
3318
 
3319
  /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section.  Most
3320
     sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
3321
     eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
3322
     at least in that case.  */
3323
  for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3324
    {
3325
      if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3326
        {
3327
          if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
3328
            num_locals++;
3329
          else
3330
            num_globals++;
3331
        }
3332
    }
3333
 
3334
  /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first.  */
3335
  new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
3336
                                      sizeof (asymbol *));
3337
 
3338
  if (new_syms == NULL)
3339
    return FALSE;
3340
 
3341
  for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3342
    {
3343
      asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3344
      unsigned int i;
3345
 
3346
      if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3347
        continue;
3348
      if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3349
        i = num_locals2++;
3350
      else
3351
        i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3352
      new_syms[i] = sym;
3353
      sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3354
    }
3355
  for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3356
    {
3357
      if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3358
        {
3359
          asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
3360
          unsigned int i;
3361
 
3362
          sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
3363
          if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3364
            i = num_locals2++;
3365
          else
3366
            i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3367
          new_syms[i] = sym;
3368
          sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3369
        }
3370
    }
3371
 
3372
  bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
3373
 
3374
  elf_num_locals (abfd) = num_locals;
3375
  elf_num_globals (abfd) = num_globals;
3376
  return TRUE;
3377
}
3378
 
3379
/* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
3380
   ELF data structure.  */
3381
 
3382
static inline file_ptr
3383
align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
3384
{
3385
  return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
3386
}
3387
 
3388
/* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
3389
   required section alignment.  */
3390
 
3391
file_ptr
3392
_bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
3393
                                           file_ptr offset,
3394
                                           bfd_boolean align)
3395
{
3396
  if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
3397
    offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
3398
  i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
3399
  if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
3400
    i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
3401
  if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
3402
    offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
3403
  return offset;
3404
}
3405
 
3406
/* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
3407
   otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file.  If LINK_INFO
3408
   is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker.  */
3409
 
3410
bfd_boolean
3411
_bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
3412
                                         struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3413
{
3414
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3415
  struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
3416
  bfd_boolean failed;
3417
  struct bfd_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
3418
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
3419
  bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3420
 
3421
  if (abfd->output_has_begun)
3422
    return TRUE;
3423
 
3424
  /* Do any elf backend specific processing first.  */
3425
  if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
3426
    (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
3427
 
3428
  if (! prep_headers (abfd))
3429
    return FALSE;
3430
 
3431
  /* Post process the headers if necessary.  */
3432
  if (bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers)
3433
    (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
3434
 
3435
  fsargs.failed = FALSE;
3436
  fsargs.link_info = link_info;
3437
  bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
3438
  if (fsargs.failed)
3439
    return FALSE;
3440
 
3441
  if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
3442
    return FALSE;
3443
 
3444
  /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself.  */
3445
  need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
3446
                 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3447
                     || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3448
                         == HAS_RELOC)));
3449
  if (need_symtab)
3450
    {
3451
      /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link.  */
3452
      int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
3453
 
3454
      if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
3455
        return FALSE;
3456
    }
3457
 
3458
  failed = FALSE;
3459
  if (link_info == NULL)
3460
    {
3461
      bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
3462
      if (failed)
3463
        return FALSE;
3464
    }
3465
 
3466
  shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
3467
  /* sh_name was set in prep_headers.  */
3468
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
3469
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3470
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3471
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3472
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3473
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3474
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
3475
  /* sh_offset is set in assign_file_positions_except_relocs.  */
3476
  shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
3477
 
3478
  if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
3479
    return FALSE;
3480
 
3481
  if (need_symtab)
3482
    {
3483
      file_ptr off;
3484
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
3485
 
3486
      off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
3487
 
3488
      hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
3489
      off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3490
 
3491
      hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3492
      if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
3493
        off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3494
 
3495
      hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
3496
      off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3497
 
3498
      elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
3499
 
3500
      /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
3501
         out.  */
3502
      if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
3503
          || ! _bfd_stringtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
3504
        return FALSE;
3505
      _bfd_stringtab_free (strtab);
3506
    }
3507
 
3508
  abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
3509
 
3510
  return TRUE;
3511
}
3512
 
3513
/* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header.  If we
3514
   get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement.  */
3515
 
3516
static bfd_size_type
3517
get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3518
{
3519
  size_t segs;
3520
  asection *s;
3521
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3522
 
3523
  /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
3524
     and one for data.  */
3525
  segs = 2;
3526
 
3527
  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3528
  if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3529
    {
3530
      /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
3531
         PT_INTERP segment.  In this case, assume we also need a
3532
         PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
3533
         targets.  */
3534
      segs += 2;
3535
    }
3536
 
3537
  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
3538
    {
3539
      /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
3540
      ++segs;
3541
    }
3542
 
3543
  if (info != NULL && info->relro)
3544
    {
3545
      /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
3546
      ++segs;
3547
    }
3548
 
3549
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr)
3550
    {
3551
      /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment.  */
3552
      ++segs;
3553
    }
3554
 
3555
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
3556
    {
3557
      /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment.  */
3558
      ++segs;
3559
    }
3560
 
3561
  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3562
    {
3563
      if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3564
          && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
3565
        {
3566
          /* We need a PT_NOTE segment.  */
3567
          ++segs;
3568
          /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
3569
             for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
3570
             gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
3571
             (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
3572
             each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
3573
             so we check whether the sections are correctly
3574
             aligned.  */
3575
          if (s->alignment_power == 2)
3576
            while (s->next != NULL
3577
                   && s->next->alignment_power == 2
3578
                   && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3579
                   && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
3580
              s = s->next;
3581
        }
3582
    }
3583
 
3584
  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3585
    {
3586
      if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3587
        {
3588
          /* We need a PT_TLS segment.  */
3589
          ++segs;
3590
          break;
3591
        }
3592
    }
3593
 
3594
  /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need.  */
3595
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3596
  if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
3597
    {
3598
      int a;
3599
 
3600
      a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
3601
      if (a == -1)
3602
        abort ();
3603
      segs += a;
3604
    }
3605
 
3606
  return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
3607
}
3608
 
3609
/* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section.  */
3610
 
3611
Elf_Internal_Phdr *
3612
_bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
3613
{
3614
  struct elf_segment_map *m;
3615
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
3616
 
3617
  for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map,
3618
         p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
3619
       m != NULL;
3620
       m = m->next, p++)
3621
    {
3622
      int i;
3623
 
3624
      for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3625
        if (m->sections[i] == section)
3626
          return p;
3627
    }
3628
 
3629
  return NULL;
3630
}
3631
 
3632
/* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment.  */
3633
 
3634
static struct elf_segment_map *
3635
make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
3636
              asection **sections,
3637
              unsigned int from,
3638
              unsigned int to,
3639
              bfd_boolean phdr)
3640
{
3641
  struct elf_segment_map *m;
3642
  unsigned int i;
3643
  asection **hdrpp;
3644
  bfd_size_type amt;
3645
 
3646
  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3647
  amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
3648
  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3649
  if (m == NULL)
3650
    return NULL;
3651
  m->next = NULL;
3652
  m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
3653
  for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
3654
    m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
3655
  m->count = to - from;
3656
 
3657
  if (from == 0 && phdr)
3658
    {
3659
      /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment.  */
3660
      m->includes_filehdr = 1;
3661
      m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3662
    }
3663
 
3664
  return m;
3665
}
3666
 
3667
/* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC.  Returns NULL
3668
   on failure.  */
3669
 
3670
struct elf_segment_map *
3671
_bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
3672
{
3673
  struct elf_segment_map *m;
3674
 
3675
  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3676
                                             sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
3677
  if (m == NULL)
3678
    return NULL;
3679
  m->next = NULL;
3680
  m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
3681
  m->count = 1;
3682
  m->sections[0] = dynsec;
3683
 
3684
  return m;
3685
}
3686
 
3687
/* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map.  */
3688
 
3689
static bfd_boolean
3690
elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
3691
                        struct bfd_link_info *info,
3692
                        bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
3693
{
3694
  struct elf_segment_map **m;
3695
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3696
 
3697
  /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
3698
     not in PT_LOAD segments.  We ensure this here by removing such
3699
     sections from the segment map.  We also remove excluded
3700
     sections.  Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
3701
     removed.  */
3702
  m = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
3703
  while (*m)
3704
    {
3705
      unsigned int i, new_count;
3706
 
3707
      for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
3708
        {
3709
          if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3710
              && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3711
                  || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
3712
            {
3713
              (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
3714
              new_count++;
3715
            }
3716
        }
3717
      (*m)->count = new_count;
3718
 
3719
      if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
3720
        *m = (*m)->next;
3721
      else
3722
        m = &(*m)->next;
3723
    }
3724
 
3725
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3726
  if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
3727
    {
3728
      if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
3729
        return FALSE;
3730
    }
3731
 
3732
  return TRUE;
3733
}
3734
 
3735
/* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments.  */
3736
 
3737
bfd_boolean
3738
_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3739
{
3740
  unsigned int count;
3741
  struct elf_segment_map *m;
3742
  asection **sections = NULL;
3743
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3744
  bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
3745
 
3746
  no_user_phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map == NULL;
3747
  if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
3748
    {
3749
      asection *s;
3750
      unsigned int i;
3751
      struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
3752
      struct elf_segment_map **pm;
3753
      asection *last_hdr;
3754
      bfd_vma last_size;
3755
      unsigned int phdr_index;
3756
      bfd_vma maxpagesize;
3757
      asection **hdrpp;
3758
      bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
3759
      bfd_boolean writable;
3760
      int tls_count = 0;
3761
      asection *first_tls = NULL;
3762
      asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
3763
      bfd_size_type amt;
3764
      bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
3765
 
3766
      /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them.  */
3767
 
3768
      sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
3769
                                            sizeof (asection *));
3770
      if (sections == NULL)
3771
        goto error_return;
3772
 
3773
      /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
3774
         left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
3775
         being shifted.  */
3776
      addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
3777
      addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
3778
 
3779
      i = 0;
3780
      for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3781
        {
3782
          if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3783
            {
3784
              sections[i] = s;
3785
              ++i;
3786
              /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header.  */
3787
              if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
3788
                wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
3789
            }
3790
        }
3791
      BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
3792
      count = i;
3793
 
3794
      qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
3795
 
3796
      /* Build the mapping.  */
3797
 
3798
      mfirst = NULL;
3799
      pm = &mfirst;
3800
 
3801
      /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
3802
         the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
3803
         section.  */
3804
      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3805
      if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3806
        {
3807
          amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3808
          m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3809
          if (m == NULL)
3810
            goto error_return;
3811
          m->next = NULL;
3812
          m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
3813
          /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not.  */
3814
          m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
3815
          m->p_flags_valid = 1;
3816
          m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3817
 
3818
          *pm = m;
3819
          pm = &m->next;
3820
 
3821
          amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3822
          m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3823
          if (m == NULL)
3824
            goto error_return;
3825
          m->next = NULL;
3826
          m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
3827
          m->count = 1;
3828
          m->sections[0] = s;
3829
 
3830
          *pm = m;
3831
          pm = &m->next;
3832
        }
3833
 
3834
      /* Look through the sections.  We put sections in the same program
3835
         segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
3836
         a few bytes of the end of the first section.  */
3837
      last_hdr = NULL;
3838
      last_size = 0;
3839
      phdr_index = 0;
3840
      maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
3841
      writable = FALSE;
3842
      dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
3843
      if (dynsec != NULL
3844
          && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
3845
        dynsec = NULL;
3846
 
3847
      /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
3848
         is not adjacent to the program headers.  This is an
3849
         approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
3850
         program headers we will need.  */
3851
      if (count > 0)
3852
        {
3853
          bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
3854
 
3855
          if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
3856
            phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
3857
          if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
3858
              || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
3859
              || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
3860
                  < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
3861
              || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
3862
            phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
3863
        }
3864
 
3865
      for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
3866
        {
3867
          asection *hdr;
3868
          bfd_boolean new_segment;
3869
 
3870
          hdr = *hdrpp;
3871
 
3872
          /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
3873
             segment.  */
3874
 
3875
          if (last_hdr == NULL)
3876
            {
3877
              /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
3878
                 one (we build the last one after this loop).  */
3879
              new_segment = FALSE;
3880
            }
3881
          else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
3882
            {
3883
              /* If this section has a different relation between the
3884
                 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
3885
                 segment.  */
3886
              new_segment = TRUE;
3887
            }
3888
          else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
3889
                   || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
3890
            {
3891
              /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
3892
                 the previous section, then we need a new segment.  */
3893
              new_segment = TRUE;
3894
            }
3895
          /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
3896
             to the end of the address space.  If the aligned address wraps
3897
             around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
3898
             pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
3899
             section can be included in the current segment.  */
3900
          else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
3901
                    > last_hdr->lma)
3902
                   && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
3903
                       <= hdr->lma))
3904
            {
3905
              /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
3906
                 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment.  */
3907
              new_segment = TRUE;
3908
            }
3909
          else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
3910
                   && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
3911
            {
3912
              /* We don't want to put a loadable section after a
3913
                 nonloadable section in the same segment.
3914
                 Consider .tbss sections as loadable for this purpose.  */
3915
              new_segment = TRUE;
3916
            }
3917
          else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
3918
            {
3919
              /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
3920
                 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
3921
                 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment.  */
3922
              new_segment = FALSE;
3923
            }
3924
          else if (! writable
3925
                   && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
3926
                   && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
3927
                       != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
3928
            {
3929
              /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
3930
                 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
3931
                 anyhow.  We already know that the last section does not
3932
                 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
3933
                 only case in which the new section is not on the same
3934
                 page as the previous section is when the previous section
3935
                 ends precisely on a page boundary.  */
3936
              new_segment = TRUE;
3937
            }
3938
          else
3939
            {
3940
              /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment.  */
3941
              new_segment = FALSE;
3942
            }
3943
 
3944
          /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision.  */
3945
          if (last_hdr != NULL
3946
              && info != NULL
3947
              && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
3948
            new_segment
3949
              = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
3950
                                                              last_hdr,
3951
                                                              new_segment);
3952
 
3953
          if (! new_segment)
3954
            {
3955
              if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3956
                writable = TRUE;
3957
              last_hdr = hdr;
3958
              /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
3959
              if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
3960
                  != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3961
                last_size = hdr->size;
3962
              else
3963
                last_size = 0;
3964
              continue;
3965
            }
3966
 
3967
          /* We need a new program segment.  We must create a new program
3968
             header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr.  */
3969
 
3970
          m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
3971
          if (m == NULL)
3972
            goto error_return;
3973
 
3974
          *pm = m;
3975
          pm = &m->next;
3976
 
3977
          if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3978
            writable = TRUE;
3979
          else
3980
            writable = FALSE;
3981
 
3982
          last_hdr = hdr;
3983
          /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
3984
          if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3985
            last_size = hdr->size;
3986
          else
3987
            last_size = 0;
3988
          phdr_index = i;
3989
          phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
3990
        }
3991
 
3992
      /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
3993
         for .tbss.  */
3994
      if (last_hdr != NULL
3995
          && (i - phdr_index != 1
3996
              || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
3997
                  != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
3998
        {
3999
          m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4000
          if (m == NULL)
4001
            goto error_return;
4002
 
4003
          *pm = m;
4004
          pm = &m->next;
4005
        }
4006
 
4007
      /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
4008
      if (dynsec != NULL)
4009
        {
4010
          m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4011
          if (m == NULL)
4012
            goto error_return;
4013
          *pm = m;
4014
          pm = &m->next;
4015
        }
4016
 
4017
      /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4018
         add a PT_NOTE segment.  We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4019
         because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4020
         loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4021
         in the output file.  FIXME: Using names for section types is
4022
         bogus anyhow.  */
4023
      for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4024
        {
4025
          if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4026
              && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4027
            {
4028
              asection *s2;
4029
 
4030
              count = 1;
4031
              amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4032
              if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4033
                for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4034
                  {
4035
                    if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4036
                        && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4037
                        && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4038
                        && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4039
                           == s2->next->lma)
4040
                      count++;
4041
                    else
4042
                      break;
4043
                  }
4044
              amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4045
              m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4046
              if (m == NULL)
4047
                goto error_return;
4048
              m->next = NULL;
4049
              m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4050
              m->count = count;
4051
              while (count > 1)
4052
                {
4053
                  m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4054
                  BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4055
                  s = s->next;
4056
                }
4057
              m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4058
              BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4059
              *pm = m;
4060
              pm = &m->next;
4061
            }
4062
          if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4063
            {
4064
              if (! tls_count)
4065
                first_tls = s;
4066
              tls_count++;
4067
            }
4068
        }
4069
 
4070
      /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment.  */
4071
      if (tls_count > 0)
4072
        {
4073
          amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4074
          amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4075
          m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4076
          if (m == NULL)
4077
            goto error_return;
4078
          m->next = NULL;
4079
          m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4080
          m->count = tls_count;
4081
          /* Mandated PF_R.  */
4082
          m->p_flags = PF_R;
4083
          m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4084
          for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4085
            {
4086
              BFD_ASSERT (first_tls->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL);
4087
              m->sections[i] = first_tls;
4088
              first_tls = first_tls->next;
4089
            }
4090
 
4091
          *pm = m;
4092
          pm = &m->next;
4093
        }
4094
 
4095
      /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4096
         segment.  */
4097
      eh_frame_hdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr;
4098
      if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4099
          && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4100
        {
4101
          amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4102
          m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4103
          if (m == NULL)
4104
            goto error_return;
4105
          m->next = NULL;
4106
          m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4107
          m->count = 1;
4108
          m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4109
 
4110
          *pm = m;
4111
          pm = &m->next;
4112
        }
4113
 
4114
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
4115
        {
4116
          amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4117
          m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4118
          if (m == NULL)
4119
            goto error_return;
4120
          m->next = NULL;
4121
          m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4122
          m->p_flags = elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags;
4123
          m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4124
 
4125
          *pm = m;
4126
          pm = &m->next;
4127
        }
4128
 
4129
      if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4130
        {
4131
          for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4132
            {
4133
              if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD)
4134
                {
4135
                  asection *last = m->sections[m->count - 1];
4136
                  bfd_vma vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma;
4137
                  bfd_vma filesz = last->vma - vaddr + last->size;
4138
 
4139
                  if (vaddr < info->relro_end
4140
                      && vaddr >= info->relro_start
4141
                      && (vaddr + filesz) >= info->relro_end)
4142
                    break;
4143
                }
4144
              }
4145
 
4146
          /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty.  */
4147
          if (m != NULL)
4148
            {
4149
              amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4150
              m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4151
              if (m == NULL)
4152
                goto error_return;
4153
              m->next = NULL;
4154
              m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
4155
              m->p_flags = PF_R;
4156
              m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4157
 
4158
              *pm = m;
4159
              pm = &m->next;
4160
            }
4161
        }
4162
 
4163
      free (sections);
4164
      elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map = mfirst;
4165
    }
4166
 
4167
  if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
4168
    return FALSE;
4169
 
4170
  for (count = 0, m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4171
    ++count;
4172
  elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4173
 
4174
  return TRUE;
4175
 
4176
 error_return:
4177
  if (sections != NULL)
4178
    free (sections);
4179
  return FALSE;
4180
}
4181
 
4182
/* Sort sections by address.  */
4183
 
4184
static int
4185
elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
4186
{
4187
  const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
4188
  const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
4189
  bfd_size_type size1, size2;
4190
 
4191
  /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
4192
     place the section into a segment.  */
4193
  if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
4194
    return -1;
4195
  else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
4196
    return 1;
4197
 
4198
  /* Then sort by VMA.  Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
4199
     the same, and this will do nothing.  */
4200
  if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
4201
    return -1;
4202
  else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
4203
    return 1;
4204
 
4205
  /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones.  */
4206
 
4207
#define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
4208
 
4209
  if (TOEND (sec1))
4210
    {
4211
      if (TOEND (sec2))
4212
        {
4213
          /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
4214
             here, but continue to try the next comparison.  */
4215
          if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
4216
            return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4217
        }
4218
      else
4219
        return 1;
4220
    }
4221
  else if (TOEND (sec2))
4222
    return -1;
4223
 
4224
#undef TOEND
4225
 
4226
  /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
4227
     before others at the same address.  */
4228
 
4229
  size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
4230
  size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
4231
 
4232
  if (size1 < size2)
4233
    return -1;
4234
  if (size1 > size2)
4235
    return 1;
4236
 
4237
  return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4238
}
4239
 
4240
/* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
4241
 
4242
   We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number.  That's just
4243
   not good.  We have to make sure either that the number is not
4244
   negative, or that the number has an unsigned type.  When the types
4245
   are all the same size they wind up as unsigned.  When file_ptr is a
4246
   larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
4247
   which is wrong.
4248
 
4249
   What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
4250
   the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
4251
   the page size.''  */
4252
/* In other words, something like:
4253
 
4254
   vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
4255
   off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
4256
   if (vma_offset < off_offset)
4257
     adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
4258
   else
4259
     adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
4260
 
4261
   which can can be collapsed into the expression below.  */
4262
 
4263
static file_ptr
4264
vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
4265
{
4266
  return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
4267
}
4268
 
4269
static void
4270
print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
4271
{
4272
  unsigned int j;
4273
  const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
4274
  char buf[32];
4275
 
4276
  if (pt == NULL)
4277
    {
4278
      if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
4279
        sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
4280
                 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
4281
      else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
4282
        sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
4283
                 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
4284
      else
4285
        snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
4286
                  (unsigned int) m->p_type);
4287
      pt = buf;
4288
    }
4289
  fflush (stdout);
4290
  fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
4291
  for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
4292
    fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
4293
  putc ('\n',stderr);
4294
  fflush (stderr);
4295
}
4296
 
4297
static bfd_boolean
4298
write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
4299
{
4300
  void *buf;
4301
  bfd_boolean ret;
4302
 
4303
  if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
4304
    return FALSE;
4305
  buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
4306
  if (buf == NULL)
4307
    return FALSE;
4308
  ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
4309
  free (buf);
4310
  return ret;
4311
}
4312
 
4313
/* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
4314
   sections to segments.  This function also sets up some fields in
4315
   the file header.  */
4316
 
4317
static bfd_boolean
4318
assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4319
                                         struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4320
{
4321
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4322
  struct elf_segment_map *m;
4323
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4324
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4325
  file_ptr off;
4326
  bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
4327
  unsigned int alloc;
4328
  unsigned int i, j;
4329
  bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
4330
 
4331
  if (link_info == NULL
4332
      && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
4333
    return FALSE;
4334
 
4335
  alloc = 0;
4336
  for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4337
    {
4338
      ++alloc;
4339
      if (m->header_size)
4340
        header_pad = m->header_size;
4341
    }
4342
 
4343
  if (alloc)
4344
    {
4345
      elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4346
      elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4347
    }
4348
  else
4349
    {
4350
      /* PR binutils/12467.  */
4351
      elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
4352
      elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
4353
    }
4354
 
4355
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
4356
 
4357
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4358
    elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4359
  else
4360
    BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size
4361
                >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
4362
 
4363
  if (alloc == 0)
4364
    {
4365
      elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4366
      return TRUE;
4367
    }
4368
 
4369
  /* We're writing the size in elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size,
4370
     see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
4371
     that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
4372
     The variable alloc contains the computed need, while elf_tdata
4373
     (abfd)->program_header_size contains the size used for the
4374
     layout.
4375
     See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
4376
     where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
4377
     last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header.  */
4378
  BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
4379
              == 0);
4380
  phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
4381
     bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
4382
                  (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
4383
                  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
4384
  elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
4385
  if (phdrs == NULL)
4386
    return FALSE;
4387
 
4388
  maxpagesize = 1;
4389
  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4390
    maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4391
 
4392
  off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4393
  off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4394
  if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
4395
    header_pad = 0;
4396
  else
4397
    header_pad -= off;
4398
  off += header_pad;
4399
 
4400
  for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs, j = 0;
4401
       m != NULL;
4402
       m = m->next, p++, j++)
4403
    {
4404
      asection **secpp;
4405
      bfd_vma off_adjust;
4406
      bfd_boolean no_contents;
4407
 
4408
      /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
4409
         sections may not be correctly ordered.  NOTE: sorting should
4410
         not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
4411
         contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
4412
         Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly.  */
4413
      if (m->count > 1
4414
          && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
4415
               && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
4416
        qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
4417
               elf_sort_sections);
4418
 
4419
      /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
4420
         number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
4421
         and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
4422
         that just contribute to p_memsz.  In this loop, OFF tracks next
4423
         available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments.  */
4424
      p->p_type = m->p_type;
4425
      p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
4426
 
4427
      if (m->count == 0)
4428
        p->p_vaddr = 0;
4429
      else
4430
        p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4431
 
4432
      if (m->p_paddr_valid)
4433
        p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
4434
      else if (m->count == 0)
4435
        p->p_paddr = 0;
4436
      else
4437
        p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4438
 
4439
      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4440
          && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4441
        {
4442
          /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
4443
             the maximum page size.  When copying an executable with
4444
             objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file.  Use this
4445
             value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
4446
             may be different.  Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
4447
             segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
4448
             on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
4449
             segment.  */
4450
          if (m->p_align_valid)
4451
            maxpagesize = m->p_align;
4452
 
4453
          p->p_align = maxpagesize;
4454
        }
4455
      else if (m->p_align_valid)
4456
        p->p_align = m->p_align;
4457
      else if (m->count == 0)
4458
        p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
4459
      else
4460
        p->p_align = 0;
4461
 
4462
      no_contents = FALSE;
4463
      off_adjust = 0;
4464
      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4465
          && m->count > 0)
4466
        {
4467
          bfd_size_type align;
4468
          unsigned int align_power = 0;
4469
 
4470
          if (m->p_align_valid)
4471
            align = p->p_align;
4472
          else
4473
            {
4474
              for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4475
                {
4476
                  unsigned int secalign;
4477
 
4478
                  secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
4479
                  if (secalign > align_power)
4480
                    align_power = secalign;
4481
                }
4482
              align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
4483
              if (align < maxpagesize)
4484
                align = maxpagesize;
4485
            }
4486
 
4487
          for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4488
            if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
4489
              /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
4490
                 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
4491
                 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section.  */
4492
              elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
4493
 
4494
          /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
4495
             sections.  */
4496
          no_contents = TRUE;
4497
          for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4498
            if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
4499
              {
4500
                no_contents = FALSE;
4501
                break;
4502
              }
4503
 
4504
          off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
4505
          off += off_adjust;
4506
          if (no_contents)
4507
            {
4508
              /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
4509
                 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
4510
                 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
4511
                 checks it.  So to comply with the alignment
4512
                 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
4513
                 p_offset for just this segment.  (OFF_ADJUST is
4514
                 subtracted from OFF later.)  This may put p_offset
4515
                 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter.  */
4516
            }
4517
          else
4518
            off_adjust = 0;
4519
        }
4520
      /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
4521
         PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
4522
      else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
4523
               && m->count > 1
4524
               && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
4525
        {
4526
          _bfd_error_handler
4527
            (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
4528
             abfd);
4529
          bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4530
          return FALSE;
4531
        }
4532
      /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE.  */
4533
      else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
4534
        for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4535
          elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
4536
 
4537
      p->p_offset = 0;
4538
      p->p_filesz = 0;
4539
      p->p_memsz = 0;
4540
 
4541
      if (m->includes_filehdr)
4542
        {
4543
          if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4544
            p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4545
          p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4546
          p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4547
          if (m->count > 0)
4548
            {
4549
              BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
4550
 
4551
              if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
4552
                {
4553
                  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4554
                    (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
4555
                     abfd);
4556
                  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4557
                  return FALSE;
4558
                }
4559
 
4560
              p->p_vaddr -= off;
4561
              if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4562
                p->p_paddr -= off;
4563
            }
4564
        }
4565
 
4566
      if (m->includes_phdrs)
4567
        {
4568
          if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4569
            p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4570
 
4571
          if (!m->includes_filehdr)
4572
            {
4573
              p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4574
 
4575
              if (m->count > 0)
4576
                {
4577
                  BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
4578
                  p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4579
                  if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4580
                    p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4581
                }
4582
            }
4583
 
4584
          p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4585
          p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4586
          if (m->count)
4587
            {
4588
              p->p_filesz += header_pad;
4589
              p->p_memsz += header_pad;
4590
            }
4591
        }
4592
 
4593
      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4594
          || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
4595
        {
4596
          if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
4597
            p->p_offset = off;
4598
          else
4599
            {
4600
              file_ptr adjust;
4601
 
4602
              adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
4603
              if (!no_contents)
4604
                p->p_filesz += adjust;
4605
              p->p_memsz += adjust;
4606
            }
4607
        }
4608
 
4609
      /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
4610
         maps.  Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
4611
         core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
4612
         assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
4613
         for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments.  */
4614
      for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4615
        {
4616
          asection *sec;
4617
          bfd_size_type align;
4618
          Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4619
 
4620
          sec = *secpp;
4621
          this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
4622
          align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
4623
 
4624
          if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4625
               || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4626
              && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
4627
                  || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
4628
                      && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
4629
                          || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
4630
            {
4631
              bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
4632
              bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
4633
              bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
4634
              bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
4635
 
4636
              if (adjust != 0
4637
                  && (s_start < p_end
4638
                      || p_end < p_start))
4639
                {
4640
                  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4641
                    (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
4642
                     (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
4643
                  adjust = 0;
4644
                  sec->lma = p_end;
4645
                }
4646
              p->p_memsz += adjust;
4647
 
4648
              if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4649
                {
4650
                  if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
4651
                    {
4652
                      /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
4653
                         Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
4654
                         zero it.  */
4655
                      adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
4656
                      if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
4657
                        return FALSE;
4658
                    }
4659
                  off += adjust;
4660
                  p->p_filesz += adjust;
4661
                }
4662
            }
4663
 
4664
          if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
4665
            {
4666
              /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
4667
                 everything.  */
4668
              if (i == 0)
4669
                {
4670
                  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4671
                  off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4672
                  p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
4673
                  p->p_memsz = 0;
4674
                  p->p_align = 1;
4675
                }
4676
              else
4677
                {
4678
                  /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written.  */
4679
                  sec->filepos = 0;
4680
                  sec->size = 0;
4681
                  sec->flags = 0;
4682
                  continue;
4683
                }
4684
            }
4685
          else
4686
            {
4687 161 khays
              if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
4688 14 khays
                {
4689 161 khays
                  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4690
                  if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4691
                    off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4692 14 khays
                }
4693 161 khays
              else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4694
                       && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
4695
                       && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
4696
                {
4697
                  /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
4698
                     (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
4699
                     final PT_LOAD".)  Set sh_offset to the value it
4700
                     would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
4701
                     p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section.  This
4702
                     also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
4703
                     p_offset value.  */
4704
                  bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
4705
                                                          off, align);
4706
                  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
4707
                }
4708 14 khays
 
4709
              if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4710
                {
4711
                  p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4712
                  /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
4713
                     a note section in a PT_NOTE segment.  These take
4714
                     file space but are not loaded into memory.  */
4715
                  if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4716
                    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4717
                }
4718
              else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4719
                {
4720
                  if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4721
                    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4722
 
4723
                  /* .tbss is special.  It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
4724
                     normal segments.  */
4725
                  else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
4726
                    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4727
                }
4728
 
4729
              if (align > p->p_align
4730
                  && !m->p_align_valid
4731
                  && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4732
                      || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
4733
                p->p_align = align;
4734
            }
4735
 
4736
          if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4737
            {
4738
              p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4739
              if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
4740
                p->p_flags |= PF_X;
4741
              if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
4742
                p->p_flags |= PF_W;
4743
            }
4744
        }
4745
      off -= off_adjust;
4746
 
4747
      /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
4748
         Don't check funky gdb generated core files.  */
4749
      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
4750
        {
4751
          bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
4752
 
4753
          for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
4754
            if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
4755
                && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
4756
                                       ->this_hdr), p) != 0
4757
                && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
4758
                                       ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
4759
              {
4760
                /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment.  */
4761
                check_vma = FALSE;
4762
                break;
4763
              }
4764
 
4765
          for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4766
            {
4767
              Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4768
              asection *sec;
4769
 
4770
              sec = m->sections[i];
4771
              this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
4772
              if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
4773
                  && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
4774
                {
4775
                  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4776
                    (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
4777
                     abfd, sec, j);
4778
                  print_segment_map (m);
4779
                }
4780
            }
4781
        }
4782
    }
4783
 
4784
  elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
4785
  return TRUE;
4786
}
4787
 
4788
/* Assign file positions for the other sections.  */
4789
 
4790
static bfd_boolean
4791
assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4792
                                             struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4793
{
4794
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4795
  Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
4796
  Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
4797
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4798
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4799
  struct elf_segment_map *m;
4800
  bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
4801
  bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
4802
  file_ptr off;
4803
  unsigned int num_sec;
4804
  unsigned int i;
4805
  unsigned int count;
4806
 
4807
  i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4808
  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
4809
  off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
4810
  for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
4811
    {
4812
      struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
4813
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4814
 
4815
      hdr = *hdrpp;
4816
      if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4817
          && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
4818
              || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4819
                  && hdr->contents == NULL)))
4820
        BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
4821
      else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4822
        {
4823
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
4824
            (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
4825
             abfd,
4826
             (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
4827
              ? "*unknown*"
4828
              : hdr->bfd_section->name));
4829
          /* We don't need to page align empty sections.  */
4830
          if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
4831
            off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4832
                                          bed->maxpagesize);
4833
          else
4834
            off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4835
                                          hdr->sh_addralign);
4836
          off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
4837
                                                           FALSE);
4838
        }
4839
      else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
4840
                && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
4841
               || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_section]
4842
               || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_shndx_section]
4843
               || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->strtab_section])
4844
        hdr->sh_offset = -1;
4845
      else
4846
        off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4847
    }
4848
 
4849
  /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
4850
     the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments.  */
4851
  count = 0;
4852
  filehdr_vaddr = 0;
4853
  filehdr_paddr = 0;
4854
  phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4855
  phdrs_paddr = 0;
4856
  phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4857
  for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
4858
       m != NULL;
4859
       m = m->next, p++)
4860
    {
4861
      ++count;
4862
      if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
4863
        continue;
4864
 
4865
      if (m->includes_filehdr)
4866
        {
4867
          filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4868
          filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4869
        }
4870
      if (m->includes_phdrs)
4871
        {
4872
          phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4873
          phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4874
          if (m->includes_filehdr)
4875
            {
4876
              phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4877
              phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4878
            }
4879
        }
4880
    }
4881
 
4882
  for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
4883
       m != NULL;
4884
       m = m->next, p++)
4885
    {
4886
      if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
4887
        {
4888
          const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
4889
 
4890
          BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
4891
 
4892
          if (link_info != NULL)
4893
            {
4894
              /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
4895
                 in link_info.  */
4896
              for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
4897
                {
4898
                  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
4899
                      && lp->p_vaddr >= link_info->relro_start
4900
                      && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
4901
                      && lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz >= link_info->relro_end)
4902
                    break;
4903
                }
4904
            }
4905
          else
4906
            {
4907
              /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
4908
                 library, but we need to use the same linker logic.  */
4909
              for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
4910
                {
4911
                  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
4912
                      && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
4913
                    break;
4914
                }
4915
            }
4916
 
4917
          if (lp < phdrs + count)
4918
            {
4919
              p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
4920
              p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
4921
              p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
4922
              if (link_info != NULL)
4923
                p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
4924
              else if (m->p_size_valid)
4925
                p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
4926
              else
4927
                abort ();
4928
              p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
4929
              p->p_align = 1;
4930
              p->p_flags = (lp->p_flags & ~PF_W);
4931
            }
4932
          else
4933
            {
4934
              memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
4935
              p->p_type = PT_NULL;
4936
            }
4937
        }
4938
      else if (m->count != 0)
4939
        {
4940
          if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4941
              && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
4942
                  || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
4943
            {
4944
              BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
4945
 
4946
              p->p_filesz = 0;
4947
              p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
4948
              for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
4949
                {
4950
                  asection *sect = m->sections[i];
4951
                  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
4952
                  if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4953
                    {
4954
                      p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
4955
                                     + hdr->sh_size);
4956
                      break;
4957
                    }
4958
                }
4959
            }
4960
        }
4961
      else if (m->includes_filehdr)
4962
        {
4963
          p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
4964
          if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
4965
            p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
4966
        }
4967
      else if (m->includes_phdrs)
4968
        {
4969
          p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
4970
          if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
4971
            p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
4972
        }
4973
    }
4974
 
4975
  elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
4976
 
4977
  return TRUE;
4978
}
4979
 
4980
/* Work out the file positions of all the sections.  This is called by
4981
   _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions.  All the section sizes and
4982
   VMAs must be known before this is called.
4983
 
4984
   Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
4985
   "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
4986
   those that bfd doesn't process as relocations.  The latter sort are
4987
   stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr.   We don't
4988
   consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
4989
   image.  Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
4990
   assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
4991
 
4992
   We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here.  */
4993
 
4994
static bfd_boolean
4995
assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
4996
                                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4997
{
4998
  struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
4999
  Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5000
  file_ptr off;
5001
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5002
 
5003
  if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
5004
      && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5005
    {
5006
      Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5007
      unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5008
      Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
5009
      unsigned int i;
5010
 
5011
      /* Start after the ELF header.  */
5012
      off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
5013
 
5014
      /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
5015
         not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
5016
         the sections in the file is unimportant.  */
5017
      for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
5018
        {
5019
          Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5020
 
5021
          hdr = *hdrpp;
5022
          if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5023
               && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5024
              || i == tdata->symtab_section
5025
              || i == tdata->symtab_shndx_section
5026
              || i == tdata->strtab_section)
5027
            {
5028
              hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5029
            }
5030
          else
5031
            off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5032
        }
5033
    }
5034
  else
5035
    {
5036
      unsigned int alloc;
5037
 
5038
      /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
5039
         assignment of sections to segments.  */
5040
      if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5041
        return FALSE;
5042
 
5043
      /* And for non-load sections.  */
5044
      if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5045
        return FALSE;
5046
 
5047
      if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
5048
        {
5049
          if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
5050
            return FALSE;
5051
        }
5052
 
5053
      /* Write out the program headers.  */
5054
      alloc = tdata->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5055
      if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
5056
          || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
5057
        return FALSE;
5058
 
5059
      off = tdata->next_file_pos;
5060
    }
5061
 
5062
  /* Place the section headers.  */
5063
  off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
5064
  i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
5065
  off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
5066
 
5067
  tdata->next_file_pos = off;
5068
 
5069
  return TRUE;
5070
}
5071
 
5072
static bfd_boolean
5073
prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
5074
{
5075
  Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;   /* Elf file header, internal form.  */
5076
  struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
5077
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5078
 
5079
  i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5080
 
5081
  shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
5082
  if (shstrtab == NULL)
5083
    return FALSE;
5084
 
5085
  elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
5086
 
5087
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
5088
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
5089
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
5090
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
5091
 
5092
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
5093
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
5094
    bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
5095
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
5096
 
5097
  if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5098
    i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
5099
  else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
5100
    i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5101
  else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5102
    i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
5103
  else
5104
    i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
5105
 
5106
  switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
5107
    {
5108
    case bfd_arch_unknown:
5109
      i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
5110
      break;
5111
 
5112
      /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
5113
         e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
5114
         in the corresponding bfd definition.  To avoid duplication,
5115
         the switch was removed.  Machines that need special handling
5116
         can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
5117
         unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
5118
         Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
5119
         e_machine with the conditions used to determine it.  */
5120
    default:
5121
      i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
5122
    }
5123
 
5124
  i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
5125
  i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5126
 
5127
  /* No program header, for now.  */
5128
  i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5129
  i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5130
  i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
5131
 
5132
  /* Each bfd section is section header entry.  */
5133
  i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
5134
  i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
5135
 
5136
  /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table.  */
5137
  if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
5138
    /* It all happens later.  */
5139
    ;
5140
  else
5141
    {
5142
      i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5143
      i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5144
    }
5145
 
5146
  elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
5147
    (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
5148
  elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
5149
    (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
5150
  elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
5151
    (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
5152
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5153
      || elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5154
      || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
5155
    return FALSE;
5156
 
5157
  return TRUE;
5158
}
5159
 
5160
/* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
5161
   of the loadable file image.  */
5162
 
5163
void
5164
_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (bfd *abfd)
5165
{
5166
  file_ptr off;
5167
  unsigned int i, num_sec;
5168
  Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp;
5169
 
5170
  off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
5171
 
5172
  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5173
  for (i = 1, shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1; i < num_sec; i++, shdrpp++)
5174
    {
5175
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
5176
 
5177
      shdrp = *shdrpp;
5178
      if ((shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5179
          && shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
5180
        off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
5181
    }
5182
 
5183
  elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
5184
}
5185
 
5186
bfd_boolean
5187
_bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
5188
{
5189
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5190
  Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
5191
  bfd_boolean failed;
5192
  unsigned int count, num_sec;
5193
 
5194
  if (! abfd->output_has_begun
5195
      && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
5196
    return FALSE;
5197
 
5198
  i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5199
 
5200
  failed = FALSE;
5201
  bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
5202
  if (failed)
5203
    return FALSE;
5204
 
5205
  _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (abfd);
5206
 
5207
  /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too...  */
5208
  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5209
  for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
5210
    {
5211
      if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
5212
        (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
5213
      if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
5214
        {
5215
          bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
5216
 
5217
          if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5218
              || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
5219
            return FALSE;
5220
        }
5221
    }
5222
 
5223
  /* Write out the section header names.  */
5224
  if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
5225
      && (bfd_seek (abfd, elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5226
          || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
5227
    return FALSE;
5228
 
5229
  if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
5230
    (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd,
5231
                                                elf_tdata (abfd)->linker);
5232
 
5233
  if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
5234
    return FALSE;
5235
 
5236
  /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0].  */
5237
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->after_write_object_contents)
5238
    return (*elf_tdata (abfd)->after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
5239
 
5240
  return TRUE;
5241
}
5242
 
5243
bfd_boolean
5244
_bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
5245
{
5246
  /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file.  */
5247
  return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
5248
}
5249
 
5250
/* Given a section, search the header to find them.  */
5251
 
5252
unsigned int
5253
_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
5254
{
5255
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5256
  unsigned int sec_index;
5257
 
5258
  if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
5259
      && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
5260
    return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
5261
 
5262
  if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
5263
    sec_index = SHN_ABS;
5264
  else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
5265
    sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
5266
  else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
5267
    sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
5268
  else
5269
    sec_index = SHN_BAD;
5270
 
5271
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5272
  if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
5273
    {
5274
      int retval = sec_index;
5275
 
5276
      if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
5277
        return retval;
5278
    }
5279
 
5280
  if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
5281
    bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
5282
 
5283
  return sec_index;
5284
}
5285
 
5286
/* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
5287
   on error.  */
5288
 
5289
int
5290
_bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
5291
{
5292
  asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
5293
  int idx;
5294
  flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
5295
 
5296
  /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
5297
     own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
5298
     symbol chain, so udata is 0.  When the linker is generating
5299
     relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
5300
     input sections rather than the output section.  */
5301
  if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
5302
      && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
5303
      && asym_ptr->section)
5304
    {
5305
      asection *sec;
5306
      int indx;
5307
 
5308
      sec = asym_ptr->section;
5309
      if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
5310
        sec = sec->output_section;
5311
      if (sec->owner == abfd
5312
          && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
5313
          && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
5314
        asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
5315
    }
5316
 
5317
  idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
5318
 
5319
  if (idx == 0)
5320
    {
5321
      /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
5322
         which is used in a relocation entry.  */
5323
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
5324
        (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
5325
         abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
5326
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
5327
      return -1;
5328
    }
5329
 
5330
#if DEBUG & 4
5331
  {
5332
    fprintf (stderr,
5333
             "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
5334
             (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
5335
    fflush (stderr);
5336
  }
5337
#endif
5338
 
5339
  return idx;
5340
}
5341
 
5342
/* Rewrite program header information.  */
5343
 
5344
static bfd_boolean
5345
rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5346
{
5347
  Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5348
  struct elf_segment_map *map;
5349
  struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5350
  struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5351
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5352
  asection *section;
5353
  unsigned int i;
5354
  unsigned int num_segments;
5355
  bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
5356
  bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
5357
  bfd_vma maxpagesize;
5358
  struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
5359
  unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
5360
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5361
 
5362
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
5363
  iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
5364
 
5365
  map_first = NULL;
5366
  pointer_to_map = &map_first;
5367
 
5368
  num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5369
  maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
5370
 
5371
  /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1.  */
5372
#define SEGMENT_END(segment, start)                                     \
5373
  (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz                        \
5374
            ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
5375
 
5376
#define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment)                                  \
5377
  (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))            \
5378
    != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS)                   \
5379
   ? section->size : 0)
5380
 
5381
  /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5382
     the given segment.  VMA addresses are compared.  */
5383
#define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment)                           \
5384
  (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr                                     \
5385
   && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)                   \
5386
       <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
5387
 
5388
  /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5389
     the given segment.  LMA addresses are compared.  */
5390
#define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base)                     \
5391
  (section->lma >= base                                                 \
5392
   && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)                   \
5393
       <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
5394
 
5395
  /* Handle PT_NOTE segment.  */
5396
#define IS_NOTE(p, s)                                                   \
5397
  (p->p_type == PT_NOTE                                                 \
5398
   && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE                                  \
5399
   && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset                               \
5400
   && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size                                   \
5401
       <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5402
 
5403
  /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
5404
     etc.  */
5405
#define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s)                                          \
5406
  (IS_NOTE (p, s)                                                       \
5407
   && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core                                 \
5408
   && s->vma == 0                                                        \
5409
   && s->lma == 0)
5410
 
5411
  /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
5412
     linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
5413
     p_memsz set to 0.  */
5414
#define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s)                                      \
5415
  (p->p_vaddr == 0                                                       \
5416
   && p->p_paddr == 0                                                    \
5417
   && p->p_memsz == 0                                                    \
5418
   && p->p_filesz > 0                                                    \
5419
   && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0                         \
5420
   && s->size > 0                                                        \
5421
   && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset                               \
5422
   && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size                                   \
5423
       <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5424
 
5425
  /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
5426
     A section will be included if:
5427
       1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
5428
          if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
5429
       2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
5430
          segment.
5431
       3. There is an output section associated with it,
5432
       4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
5433
       5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
5434
       6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
5435
       7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
5436
       8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
5437
          (with the possible exception of .dynamic).  */
5438
#define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)              \
5439
  ((((segment->p_paddr                                                  \
5440
      ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr)        \
5441
      : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment))                         \
5442
     && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)                               \
5443
    || IS_NOTE (segment, section))                                      \
5444
   && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK                                   \
5445
   && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS                                        \
5446
       || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))                          \
5447
   && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD                                       \
5448
       || segment->p_type == PT_TLS                                     \
5449
       || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)                      \
5450
   && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC                                    \
5451
       || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0                            \
5452
       || (segment->p_paddr                                             \
5453
           ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma                           \
5454
           : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma)                          \
5455
       || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic")    \
5456
           == 0))                                                        \
5457
   && !section->segment_mark)
5458
 
5459
/* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
5460
   it is removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
5461
#define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)               \
5462
  (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed)          \
5463
   && section->output_section != NULL)
5464
 
5465
  /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2.  */
5466
#define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field)                        \
5467
  (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
5468
 
5469
  /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
5470
     their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
5471
     It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
5472
     ranges.  RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
5473
     to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
5474
     LMA.  */
5475
#define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2)                                    \
5476
  (   !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr)                     \
5477
        || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr))                 \
5478
   && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr)                     \
5479
        || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
5480
 
5481
  /* Initialise the segment mark field.  */
5482
  for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5483
    section->segment_mark = FALSE;
5484
 
5485
  /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
5486
     p_paddr fields are zero.  When we try to objcopy or strip such a
5487
     file, we get confused.  Check for this case, and if we find it
5488
     don't set the p_paddr_valid fields.  */
5489
  p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
5490
  for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5491
       i < num_segments;
5492
       i++, segment++)
5493
    if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
5494
      {
5495
        p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
5496
        break;
5497
      }
5498
 
5499
  /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
5500
     of the input BFD.  For this first scan we look for overlaps
5501
     in the loadable segments.  These can be created by weird
5502
     parameters to objcopy.  Also, fix some solaris weirdness.  */
5503
  for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5504
       i < num_segments;
5505
       i++, segment++)
5506
    {
5507
      unsigned int j;
5508
      Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
5509
 
5510
      if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
5511
        for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
5512
          if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
5513
            {
5514
              /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
5515
                 assignment code will work.  */
5516
              segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
5517
              break;
5518
            }
5519
 
5520
      if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5521
        {
5522
          /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
5523
          if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5524
            segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5525
          continue;
5526
        }
5527
 
5528
      /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments.  */
5529
      for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
5530
        {
5531
          bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
5532
 
5533
          if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
5534
              || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
5535
            continue;
5536
 
5537
          /* Merge the two segments together.  */
5538
          if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
5539
            {
5540
              /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
5541
                 SEGMENT.  */
5542
              extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
5543
                              - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
5544
 
5545
              if (extra_length > 0)
5546
                {
5547
                  segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
5548
                  segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
5549
                }
5550
 
5551
              segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5552
 
5553
              /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop.  */
5554
              i = 0;
5555
              segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5556
              break;
5557
            }
5558
          else
5559
            {
5560
              /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
5561
                 SEGMENT2.  */
5562
              extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
5563
                              - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
5564
 
5565
              if (extra_length > 0)
5566
                {
5567
                  segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
5568
                  segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
5569
                }
5570
 
5571
              segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
5572
            }
5573
        }
5574
    }
5575
 
5576
  /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments.  */
5577
  for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5578
       i < num_segments;
5579
       i++, segment++)
5580
    {
5581
      unsigned int section_count;
5582
      asection **sections;
5583
      asection *output_section;
5584
      unsigned int isec;
5585
      bfd_vma matching_lma;
5586
      bfd_vma suggested_lma;
5587
      unsigned int j;
5588
      bfd_size_type amt;
5589
      asection *first_section;
5590
      bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
5591
      bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
5592
 
5593
      if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
5594
        continue;
5595
 
5596
      first_section = NULL;
5597
      /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment.  */
5598
      for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
5599
           section != NULL;
5600
           section = section->next)
5601
        {
5602
          /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
5603
             removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
5604
          if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5605
            {
5606
              if (first_section == NULL)
5607
                first_section = section;
5608
              if (section->output_section != NULL)
5609
                ++section_count;
5610
            }
5611
        }
5612
 
5613
      /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
5614
         all of the sections we have selected.  */
5615
      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5616
      amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5617
      map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
5618
      if (map == NULL)
5619
        return FALSE;
5620
 
5621
      /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Default to
5622
         using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD.  */
5623
      map->next = NULL;
5624
      map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5625
      map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5626
      map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5627
 
5628
      /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
5629
         no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
5630
         output segment.  */
5631
      if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
5632
        {
5633
          map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
5634
          map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
5635
        }
5636
 
5637
      /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
5638
         and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
5639
      map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
5640
                               && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
5641
      map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5642
 
5643
      if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5644
        {
5645
          map->includes_phdrs =
5646
            (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5647
             && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
5648
                 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5649
                     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
5650
 
5651
          if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
5652
            phdr_included = TRUE;
5653
        }
5654
 
5655
      if (section_count == 0)
5656
        {
5657
          /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
5658
             no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
5659
             something.  They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
5660
             a warning is produced.  */
5661
          if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5662
            (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment"
5663
                                     " detected, is this intentional ?\n"),
5664
                                   ibfd);
5665
 
5666
          map->count = 0;
5667
          *pointer_to_map = map;
5668
          pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5669
 
5670
          continue;
5671
        }
5672
 
5673
      /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
5674
         to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
5675
         The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
5676
         been moved (ie had its LMA changed).  There are four possibilities:
5677
 
5678
         1. None of the sections have been moved.
5679
            In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
5680
            input BFD.
5681
 
5682
         2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
5683
            In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5684
            of the first section.
5685
 
5686
         3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
5687
            In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
5688
            placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
5689
            and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
5690
            have to be created to contain the other sections.
5691
 
5692
         4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
5693
            In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5694
            of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
5695
            or segments to contain the other sections.
5696
 
5697
         In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
5698
         pointers that we are interested in.  As these sections get assigned
5699
         to a segment, they are removed from this array.  */
5700
 
5701
      sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
5702
      if (sections == NULL)
5703
        return FALSE;
5704
 
5705
      /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
5706
         Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
5707
         Also add the sections to the current segment.  In the common
5708
         case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
5709
         we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
5710
         more to do.  */
5711
      isec = 0;
5712
      matching_lma = 0;
5713
      suggested_lma = 0;
5714
      first_matching_lma = TRUE;
5715
      first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
5716
 
5717
      for (section = ibfd->sections;
5718
           section != NULL;
5719
           section = section->next)
5720
        if (section == first_section)
5721
          break;
5722
 
5723
      for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5724
        {
5725
          if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5726
            {
5727
              output_section = section->output_section;
5728
 
5729
              sections[j++] = section;
5730
 
5731
              /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
5732
                 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
5733
                 correct value.  Note - some backends require that
5734
                 p_paddr be left as zero.  */
5735
              if (!p_paddr_valid
5736
                  && segment->p_vaddr != 0
5737
                  && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5738
                  && isec == 0
5739
                  && output_section->lma != 0
5740
                  && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
5741
                                             + (map->includes_filehdr
5742
                                                ? iehdr->e_ehsize
5743
                                                : 0)
5744
                                             + (map->includes_phdrs
5745
                                                ? (iehdr->e_phnum
5746
                                                   * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5747
                                                : 0)))
5748
                map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5749
 
5750
              /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
5751
                 LMA address of the output section.  */
5752
              if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5753
                  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
5754
                  || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5755
                      && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
5756
                {
5757
                  if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
5758
                    {
5759
                      matching_lma = output_section->lma;
5760
                      first_matching_lma = FALSE;
5761
                    }
5762
 
5763
                  /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
5764
                     then it does not overlap any other section within that
5765
                     segment.  */
5766
                  map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
5767
                }
5768
              else if (first_suggested_lma)
5769
                {
5770
                  suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5771
                  first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5772
                }
5773
 
5774
              if (j == section_count)
5775
                break;
5776
            }
5777
        }
5778
 
5779
      BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
5780
 
5781
      /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
5782
         if necessary.  */
5783
      if (isec == section_count)
5784
        {
5785
          /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
5786
             specified.  This is the default case.  Add the segment to
5787
             the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
5788
             program header in the input BFD.  */
5789
          map->count = section_count;
5790
          *pointer_to_map = map;
5791
          pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5792
 
5793
          if (p_paddr_valid
5794
              && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5795
              && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
5796
              && !map->includes_filehdr
5797
              && !map->includes_phdrs)
5798
            /* There is some padding before the first section in the
5799
               segment.  So, we must account for that in the output
5800
               segment's vma.  */
5801
            map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
5802
 
5803
          free (sections);
5804
          continue;
5805
        }
5806
      else
5807
        {
5808
          if (!first_matching_lma)
5809
            {
5810
              /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
5811
                 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
5812
                 LMA of the first section that fitted.  */
5813
              map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
5814
            }
5815
          else
5816
            {
5817
              /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
5818
                 Change the current segment's physical address to match
5819
                 the LMA of the first section.  */
5820
              map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5821
            }
5822
 
5823
          /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
5824
             to allow for space taken up by elf headers.  */
5825
          if (map->includes_filehdr)
5826
            {
5827
              if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
5828
                map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
5829
              else
5830
                {
5831
                  map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
5832
                  map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
5833
                }
5834
            }
5835
 
5836
          if (map->includes_phdrs)
5837
            {
5838
              if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5839
                {
5840
                  map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5841
 
5842
                  /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
5843
                     of program headers that we will need.  Make a note
5844
                     here of the number we used and the segment we chose
5845
                     to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
5846
                     offset when we know the correct value.  */
5847
                  phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
5848
                  phdr_adjust_seg = map;
5849
                }
5850
              else
5851
                map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
5852
            }
5853
        }
5854
 
5855
      /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
5856
         those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
5857
         sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps.  Once all
5858
         possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
5859
         added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
5860
         to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
5861
         the loop.  */
5862
      isec = 0;
5863
      do
5864
        {
5865
          map->count = 0;
5866
          suggested_lma = 0;
5867
          first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
5868
 
5869
          /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit.  */
5870
          for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
5871
            {
5872
              section = sections[j];
5873
 
5874
              if (section == NULL)
5875
                continue;
5876
 
5877
              output_section = section->output_section;
5878
 
5879
              BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
5880
 
5881
              if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5882
                  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
5883
                {
5884
                  if (map->count == 0)
5885
                    {
5886
                      /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
5887
                         the beginning of the segment, then something is
5888
                         wrong.  */
5889
                      if (output_section->lma
5890
                          != (map->p_paddr
5891
                              + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
5892
                              + (map->includes_phdrs
5893
                                 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
5894
                                 : 0)))
5895
                        abort ();
5896
                    }
5897
                  else
5898
                    {
5899
                      asection *prev_sec;
5900
 
5901
                      prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
5902
 
5903
                      /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
5904
                         and the start of this section is more than
5905
                         maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment.  */
5906
                      if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
5907
                                      maxpagesize)
5908
                           < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
5909
                          || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
5910
                              > output_section->lma))
5911
                        {
5912
                          if (first_suggested_lma)
5913
                            {
5914
                              suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5915
                              first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5916
                            }
5917
 
5918
                          continue;
5919
                        }
5920
                    }
5921
 
5922
                  map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
5923
                  ++isec;
5924
                  sections[j] = NULL;
5925
                  section->segment_mark = TRUE;
5926
                }
5927
              else if (first_suggested_lma)
5928
                {
5929
                  suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5930
                  first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5931
                }
5932
            }
5933
 
5934
          BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
5935
 
5936
          /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments.  */
5937
          *pointer_to_map = map;
5938
          pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5939
 
5940
          if (isec < section_count)
5941
            {
5942
              /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
5943
                 segments.  Create a new segment here, initialise it
5944
                 and carry on looping.  */
5945
              amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5946
              amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5947
              map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_alloc (obfd, amt);
5948
              if (map == NULL)
5949
                {
5950
                  free (sections);
5951
                  return FALSE;
5952
                }
5953
 
5954
              /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Set the physical
5955
                 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
5956
                 not yet been assigned.  */
5957
              map->next = NULL;
5958
              map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5959
              map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5960
              map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5961
              map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5962
              map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
5963
              map->includes_filehdr = 0;
5964
              map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5965
            }
5966
        }
5967
      while (isec < section_count);
5968
 
5969
      free (sections);
5970
    }
5971
 
5972
  elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
5973
 
5974
  /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
5975
     going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
5976
     the offset if necessary.  */
5977
  if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
5978
    {
5979
      unsigned int count;
5980
 
5981
      for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
5982
        count++;
5983
 
5984
      if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
5985
        phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
5986
          -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5987
    }
5988
 
5989
#undef SEGMENT_END
5990
#undef SECTION_SIZE
5991
#undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
5992
#undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
5993
#undef IS_NOTE
5994
#undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
5995
#undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
5996
#undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
5997
#undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
5998
#undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
5999
#undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
6000
  return TRUE;
6001
}
6002
 
6003
/* Copy ELF program header information.  */
6004
 
6005
static bfd_boolean
6006
copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6007
{
6008
  Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6009
  struct elf_segment_map *map;
6010
  struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6011
  struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6012
  Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6013
  unsigned int i;
6014
  unsigned int num_segments;
6015
  bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6016
  bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6017
 
6018
  iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6019
 
6020
  map_first = NULL;
6021
  pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6022
 
6023
  /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
6024
     map->p_paddr_valid.  */
6025
  p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6026
  num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6027
  for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6028
       i < num_segments;
6029
       i++, segment++)
6030
    if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6031
      {
6032
        p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6033
        break;
6034
      }
6035
 
6036
  for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6037
       i < num_segments;
6038
       i++, segment++)
6039
    {
6040
      asection *section;
6041
      unsigned int section_count;
6042
      bfd_size_type amt;
6043
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6044
      asection *first_section = NULL;
6045
      asection *lowest_section;
6046
 
6047
      /* Compute how many sections are in this segment.  */
6048
      for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6049
           section != NULL;
6050
           section = section->next)
6051
        {
6052
          this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6053
          if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6054
            {
6055
              if (first_section == NULL)
6056
                first_section = section;
6057
              section_count++;
6058
            }
6059
        }
6060
 
6061
      /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6062
         all of the sections we have selected.  */
6063
      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6064
      if (section_count != 0)
6065
        amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6066
      map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6067
      if (map == NULL)
6068
        return FALSE;
6069
 
6070
      /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
6071
         input segment.  */
6072
      map->next = NULL;
6073
      map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6074
      map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6075
      map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6076
      map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6077
      map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6078
      map->p_align = segment->p_align;
6079
      map->p_align_valid = 1;
6080
      map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
6081
 
6082
      if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6083
        {
6084
          /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
6085
             bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
6086
             section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  We won't
6087
             change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
6088
          map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
6089
          map->p_size_valid = 1;
6090
        }
6091
 
6092
      /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6093
         and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
6094
      map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6095
                               && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6096
 
6097
      map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6098
      if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6099
        {
6100
          map->includes_phdrs =
6101
            (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6102
             && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6103
                 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6104
                     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6105
 
6106
          if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6107
            phdr_included = TRUE;
6108
        }
6109
 
6110
      lowest_section = first_section;
6111
      if (section_count != 0)
6112
        {
6113
          unsigned int isec = 0;
6114
 
6115
          for (section = first_section;
6116
               section != NULL;
6117
               section = section->next)
6118
            {
6119
              this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6120
              if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6121
                {
6122
                  map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
6123
                  if (section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
6124
                    lowest_section = section;
6125
                  if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6126
                    {
6127
                      bfd_vma seg_off;
6128
 
6129
                      /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
6130
                         p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
6131
                         If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
6132
                         with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
6133
                         invalid.  */
6134
                      if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
6135
                        seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
6136
                      else
6137
                        seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
6138
                      if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
6139
                        map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6140
                    }
6141
                  if (isec == section_count)
6142
                    break;
6143
                }
6144
            }
6145
        }
6146
 
6147
      if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
6148
        /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed.  */
6149
        map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
6150
 
6151
      if (!map->includes_phdrs
6152
          && !map->includes_filehdr
6153
          && map->p_paddr_valid)
6154
        /* There is some other padding before the first section.  */
6155
        map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
6156
                               - segment->p_paddr);
6157
 
6158
      map->count = section_count;
6159
      *pointer_to_map = map;
6160
      pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6161
    }
6162
 
6163
  elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
6164
  return TRUE;
6165
}
6166
 
6167
/* Copy private BFD data.  This copies or rewrites ELF program header
6168
   information.  */
6169
 
6170
static bfd_boolean
6171
copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6172
{
6173
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6174
      || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6175
    return TRUE;
6176
 
6177
  if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
6178
    return TRUE;
6179
 
6180
  if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6181
    {
6182
      /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
6183
         covered by ELF program header have changed.  */
6184
      Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6185
      asection *section, *osec;
6186
      unsigned int i, num_segments;
6187
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6188
      const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6189
 
6190
      bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6191
 
6192
      /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0.  */
6193
      if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
6194
        goto rewrite;
6195
 
6196
      /* Initialize the segment mark field.  */
6197
      for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6198
           section = section->next)
6199
        section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6200
 
6201
      num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6202
      for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6203
           i < num_segments;
6204
           i++, segment++)
6205
        {
6206
          /* PR binutils/3535.  The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
6207
             and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
6208
             which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
6209
             map in this case.  */
6210
          if (segment->p_paddr == 0
6211
              && segment->p_memsz == 0
6212
              && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
6213
            goto rewrite;
6214
 
6215
          for (section = ibfd->sections;
6216
               section != NULL; section = section->next)
6217
            {
6218
              /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
6219
                 from the input BFD.  */
6220
              osec = section->output_section;
6221
              if (osec)
6222
                osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
6223
 
6224
              /* Check if this section is covered by the segment.  */
6225
              this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6226
              if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6227
                {
6228
                  /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
6229
                     removed.  What else do we need to check?  */
6230
                  if (osec == NULL
6231
                      || section->flags != osec->flags
6232
                      || section->lma != osec->lma
6233
                      || section->vma != osec->vma
6234
                      || section->size != osec->size
6235
                      || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
6236
                      || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
6237
                    goto rewrite;
6238
                }
6239
            }
6240
        }
6241
 
6242
      /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
6243
         input BFD.  */
6244
      for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6245
           section = section->next)
6246
        {
6247
          if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
6248
            goto rewrite;
6249
          else
6250
            section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6251
        }
6252
 
6253
      return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6254
    }
6255
 
6256
rewrite:
6257
  return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6258
}
6259
 
6260
/* Initialize private output section information from input section.  */
6261
 
6262
bfd_boolean
6263
_bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6264
                                    asection *isec,
6265
                                    bfd *obfd,
6266
                                    asection *osec,
6267
                                    struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6268
 
6269
{
6270
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6271
  bfd_boolean final_link = link_info != NULL && !link_info->relocatable;
6272
 
6273
  if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6274
      || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6275
    return TRUE;
6276
 
6277 148 khays
  BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
6278
 
6279 14 khays
  /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
6280
     section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
6281
     set to something different.  For a final link allow some flags
6282
     that the linker clears to differ.  */
6283
  if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
6284
      && (osec->flags == isec->flags
6285
          || (final_link
6286
              && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
6287
                  & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
6288
    elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
6289
 
6290
  /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags?  */
6291
  elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6292
                               & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
6293
 
6294
  /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link.  The output
6295
     SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
6296
     to the input group members.  Ignore linker created group section.
6297
     See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c.  */
6298
  if (!final_link)
6299
    {
6300
      if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
6301
          || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6302
        {
6303
          if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
6304
            elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
6305
          elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6306
          elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
6307
        }
6308
    }
6309
 
6310
  ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6311
 
6312
  /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
6313
     don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
6314
     may be NULL at this point.  */
6315
  if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
6316
    {
6317
      ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6318
      ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
6319
      elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
6320
    }
6321
 
6322
  osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
6323
 
6324
  return TRUE;
6325
}
6326
 
6327
/* Copy private section information.  This copies over the entsize
6328
   field, and sometimes the info field.  */
6329
 
6330
bfd_boolean
6331
_bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6332
                                    asection *isec,
6333
                                    bfd *obfd,
6334
                                    asection *osec)
6335
{
6336
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6337
 
6338
  if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6339
      || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6340
    return TRUE;
6341
 
6342
  ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6343
  ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6344
 
6345
  ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
6346
 
6347
  if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
6348
      || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
6349
      || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
6350
      || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
6351
    ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
6352
 
6353
  return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
6354
                                             NULL);
6355
}
6356
 
6357
/* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
6358
   necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
6359
   the group member sections.  DISCARDED is the value that a section's
6360
   output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
6361
   function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
6362
   from the linker.  */
6363
 
6364
bfd_boolean
6365
_bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
6366
{
6367
  asection *isec;
6368
 
6369
  for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
6370
    if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
6371
      {
6372
        asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6373
        asection *s = first;
6374
        bfd_size_type removed = 0;
6375
 
6376
        while (s != NULL)
6377
          {
6378
            /* If this member section is being output but the
6379
               SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
6380
               set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data.  */
6381
            if (s->output_section != discarded
6382
                && isec->output_section == discarded)
6383
              {
6384
                elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
6385
                elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
6386
              }
6387
            /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
6388
               but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size.  */
6389
            else if (s->output_section == discarded
6390
                     && isec->output_section != discarded)
6391
              removed += 4;
6392
            s = elf_next_in_group (s);
6393
            if (s == first)
6394
              break;
6395
          }
6396
        if (removed != 0)
6397
          {
6398
            if (discarded != NULL)
6399
              {
6400
                /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
6401
                   adjust the input section size.  This function may
6402
                   be called multiple times, so save the original
6403
                   size.  */
6404
                if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6405
                  isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6406
                isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
6407
              }
6408
            else
6409
              {
6410
                /* Adjust the output section size when called from
6411
                   objcopy. */
6412
                isec->output_section->size -= removed;
6413
              }
6414
          }
6415
      }
6416
 
6417
  return TRUE;
6418
}
6419
 
6420
/* Copy private header information.  */
6421
 
6422
bfd_boolean
6423
_bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6424
{
6425
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6426
      || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6427
    return TRUE;
6428
 
6429
  /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
6430
     This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
6431
     entry point, because the latter is called after the section
6432
     contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
6433
     already been worked out.  */
6434
  if (elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
6435
    {
6436
      if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
6437
        return FALSE;
6438
    }
6439
 
6440
  return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
6441
}
6442
 
6443
/* Copy private symbol information.  If this symbol is in a section
6444
   which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
6445
   index correctly.  We use special macro definitions for the mapped
6446
   section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
6447
   swap_out_syms function.  */
6448
 
6449
#define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
6450
#define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
6451
#define MAP_STRTAB    (SHN_HIOS + 3)
6452
#define MAP_SHSTRTAB  (SHN_HIOS + 4)
6453
#define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
6454
 
6455
bfd_boolean
6456
_bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
6457
                                   asymbol *isymarg,
6458
                                   bfd *obfd,
6459
                                   asymbol *osymarg)
6460
{
6461
  elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
6462
 
6463
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6464
      || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6465
    return TRUE;
6466
 
6467
  isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
6468
  osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
6469
 
6470
  if (isym != NULL
6471
      && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
6472
      && osym != NULL
6473
      && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
6474
    {
6475
      unsigned int shndx;
6476
 
6477
      shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6478
      if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
6479
        shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
6480
      else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
6481
        shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
6482
      else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->strtab_section)
6483
        shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
6484
      else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->shstrtab_section)
6485
        shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
6486
      else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_section)
6487
        shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
6488
      osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6489
    }
6490
 
6491
  return TRUE;
6492
}
6493
 
6494
/* Swap out the symbols.  */
6495
 
6496
static bfd_boolean
6497
swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
6498
               struct bfd_strtab_hash **sttp,
6499
               int relocatable_p)
6500
{
6501
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6502
  int symcount;
6503
  asymbol **syms;
6504
  struct bfd_strtab_hash *stt;
6505
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6506
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
6507
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
6508
  bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
6509
  bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
6510
  int idx;
6511
  bfd_size_type amt;
6512
  bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
6513
 
6514
  if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd))
6515
    return FALSE;
6516
 
6517
  /* Dump out the symtabs.  */
6518
  stt = _bfd_elf_stringtab_init ();
6519
  if (stt == NULL)
6520
    return FALSE;
6521
 
6522
  bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6523
  symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
6524
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6525
  symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
6526
  symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6527
  symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
6528
  symtab_hdr->sh_info = elf_num_locals (abfd) + 1;
6529
  symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
6530
 
6531
  symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
6532
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6533
 
6534
  outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
6535
                                           bed->s->sizeof_sym);
6536
  if (outbound_syms == NULL)
6537
    {
6538
      _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6539
      return FALSE;
6540
    }
6541
  symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
6542
 
6543
  outbound_shndx = NULL;
6544
  symtab_shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
6545
  if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
6546
    {
6547
      amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6548
      outbound_shndx =  (bfd_byte *)
6549
          bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
6550
      if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
6551
        {
6552
          _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6553
          return FALSE;
6554
        }
6555
 
6556
      symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
6557
      symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
6558
      symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
6559
      symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6560
      symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6561
    }
6562
 
6563
  /* Now generate the data (for "contents").  */
6564
  {
6565
    /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out.  */
6566
    Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6567
    sym.st_name = 0;
6568
    sym.st_value = 0;
6569
    sym.st_size = 0;
6570
    sym.st_info = 0;
6571
    sym.st_other = 0;
6572
    sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
6573
    sym.st_target_internal = 0;
6574
    bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6575
    outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6576
    if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6577
      outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6578
  }
6579
 
6580
  name_local_sections
6581
    = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
6582
       && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
6583
 
6584
  syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
6585
  for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
6586
    {
6587
      Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6588
      bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
6589
      elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
6590
      flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
6591
      int type;
6592
 
6593
      if (!name_local_sections
6594
          && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6595
        {
6596
          /* Local section symbols have no name.  */
6597
          sym.st_name = 0;
6598
        }
6599
      else
6600
        {
6601
          sym.st_name = (unsigned long) _bfd_stringtab_add (stt,
6602
                                                            syms[idx]->name,
6603
                                                            TRUE, FALSE);
6604
          if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
6605
            {
6606
              _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6607
              return FALSE;
6608
            }
6609
        }
6610
 
6611
      type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
6612
 
6613
      if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
6614
          && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6615
        {
6616
          /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
6617
             and the size into the `size' field.  This is backwards from
6618
             how BFD handles it, so reverse it here.  */
6619
          sym.st_size = value;
6620
          if (type_ptr == NULL
6621
              || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
6622
            sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
6623
          else
6624
            sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
6625
          sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
6626
            (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
6627
        }
6628
      else
6629
        {
6630
          asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
6631
          unsigned int shndx;
6632
 
6633
          if (sec->output_section)
6634
            {
6635
              value += sec->output_offset;
6636
              sec = sec->output_section;
6637
            }
6638
 
6639
          /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output.  */
6640
          if (! relocatable_p)
6641
            value += sec->vma;
6642
          sym.st_value = value;
6643
          sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
6644
 
6645
          if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
6646
              && type_ptr != NULL
6647
              && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
6648
            {
6649
              /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
6650
                 not create as a BFD section.  Undo the mapping done
6651
                 by copy_private_symbol_data.  */
6652
              shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6653
              switch (shndx)
6654
                {
6655
                case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
6656
                  shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
6657
                  break;
6658
                case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
6659
                  shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
6660
                  break;
6661
                case MAP_STRTAB:
6662
                  shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_section;
6663
                  break;
6664
                case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
6665
                  shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_section;
6666
                  break;
6667
                case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
6668
                  shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_section;
6669
                  break;
6670
                default:
6671
                  break;
6672
                }
6673
            }
6674
          else
6675
            {
6676
              shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
6677
 
6678
              if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
6679
                {
6680
                  asection *sec2;
6681
 
6682
                  /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
6683
                     we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
6684
                     knew what to expect of the library, and what to
6685
                     demand of applications.  For example, it
6686
                     appears that `objcopy' might not set the
6687
                     section of a symbol to be a section that is
6688
                     actually in the output file.  */
6689
                  sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
6690
                  if (sec2 == NULL)
6691
                    {
6692
                      _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6693
Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
6694
                                          syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
6695
                                          sec->name);
6696
                      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6697
                      _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6698
                      return FALSE;
6699
                    }
6700
 
6701
                  shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
6702
                  BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
6703
                }
6704
            }
6705
 
6706
          sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6707
        }
6708
 
6709
      if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
6710
        type = STT_TLS;
6711
      else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
6712
        type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
6713
      else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
6714
        type = STT_FUNC;
6715
      else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
6716
        type = STT_OBJECT;
6717
      else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
6718
        type = STT_RELC;
6719
      else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
6720
        type = STT_SRELC;
6721
      else
6722
        type = STT_NOTYPE;
6723
 
6724
      if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
6725
        type = STT_TLS;
6726
 
6727
      /* Processor-specific types.  */
6728
      if (type_ptr != NULL
6729
          && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6730
        type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6731
                (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
6732
 
6733
      if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6734
        {
6735
          if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6736
            sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6737
          else
6738
            sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
6739
        }
6740
      else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6741
        {
6742
#ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
6743
          if (type == STT_OBJECT)
6744
            sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
6745
          else
6746
#endif
6747
            sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
6748
        }
6749
      else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
6750
        sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
6751
                                    ? STB_WEAK
6752
                                    : STB_GLOBAL),
6753
                                   type);
6754
      else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
6755
        sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
6756
      else
6757
        {
6758
          int bind = STB_LOCAL;
6759
 
6760
          if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
6761
            bind = STB_LOCAL;
6762
          else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
6763
            bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
6764
          else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
6765
            bind = STB_WEAK;
6766
          else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6767
            bind = STB_GLOBAL;
6768
 
6769
          sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
6770
        }
6771
 
6772
      if (type_ptr != NULL)
6773
        {
6774
          sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
6775
          sym.st_target_internal
6776
            = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
6777
        }
6778
      else
6779
        {
6780
          sym.st_other = 0;
6781
          sym.st_target_internal = 0;
6782
        }
6783
 
6784
      bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6785
      outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6786
      if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6787
        outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6788
    }
6789
 
6790
  *sttp = stt;
6791
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_stringtab_size (stt);
6792
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6793
 
6794
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
6795
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
6796
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6797
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
6798
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
6799
  symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
6800
 
6801
  return TRUE;
6802
}
6803
 
6804
/* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
6805
 
6806
   Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
6807
   the vector allocated based on this size.  However, the ELF symbol table
6808
   always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even.  */
6809
 
6810
long
6811
_bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6812
{
6813
  long symcount;
6814
  long symtab_size;
6815
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6816
 
6817
  symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6818
  symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6819
  if (symcount > 0)
6820
    symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6821
 
6822
  return symtab_size;
6823
}
6824
 
6825
long
6826
_bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6827
{
6828
  long symcount;
6829
  long symtab_size;
6830
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
6831
 
6832
  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6833
    {
6834
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6835
      return -1;
6836
    }
6837
 
6838
  symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6839
  symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6840
  if (symcount > 0)
6841
    symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6842
 
6843
  return symtab_size;
6844
}
6845
 
6846
long
6847
_bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6848
                                sec_ptr asect)
6849
{
6850
  return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
6851
}
6852
 
6853
/* Canonicalize the relocs.  */
6854
 
6855
long
6856
_bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
6857
                             sec_ptr section,
6858
                             arelent **relptr,
6859
                             asymbol **symbols)
6860
{
6861
  arelent *tblptr;
6862
  unsigned int i;
6863
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6864
 
6865
  if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
6866
    return -1;
6867
 
6868
  tblptr = section->relocation;
6869
  for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
6870
    *relptr++ = tblptr++;
6871
 
6872
  *relptr = NULL;
6873
 
6874
  return section->reloc_count;
6875
}
6876
 
6877
long
6878
_bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
6879
{
6880
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6881
  long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
6882
 
6883
  if (symcount >= 0)
6884
    bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
6885
  return symcount;
6886
}
6887
 
6888
long
6889
_bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
6890
                                      asymbol **allocation)
6891
{
6892
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6893
  long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
6894
 
6895
  if (symcount >= 0)
6896
    bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
6897
  return symcount;
6898
}
6899
 
6900
/* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries.  Any loadable
6901
   section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
6902
   or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
6903
   dynamic reloc section.  */
6904
 
6905
long
6906
_bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6907
{
6908
  long ret;
6909
  asection *s;
6910
 
6911
  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6912
    {
6913
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6914
      return -1;
6915
    }
6916
 
6917
  ret = sizeof (arelent *);
6918
  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6919
    if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
6920
        && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
6921
            || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
6922
      ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
6923
              * sizeof (arelent *));
6924
 
6925
  return ret;
6926
}
6927
 
6928
/* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries.  Note that we return the
6929
   dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
6930
   associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
6931
   designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
6932
   one set of dynamic relocs.  Any loadable section that was actually
6933
   installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
6934
   dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section.  */
6935
 
6936
long
6937
_bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
6938
                                     arelent **storage,
6939
                                     asymbol **syms)
6940
{
6941
  bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
6942
  asection *s;
6943
  long ret;
6944
 
6945
  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6946
    {
6947
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6948
      return -1;
6949
    }
6950
 
6951
  slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
6952
  ret = 0;
6953
  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6954
    {
6955
      if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
6956
          && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
6957
              || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
6958
        {
6959
          arelent *p;
6960
          long count, i;
6961
 
6962
          if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
6963
            return -1;
6964
          count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
6965
          p = s->relocation;
6966
          for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
6967
            *storage++ = p++;
6968
          ret += count;
6969
        }
6970
    }
6971
 
6972
  *storage = NULL;
6973
 
6974
  return ret;
6975
}
6976
 
6977
/* Read in the version information.  */
6978
 
6979
bfd_boolean
6980
_bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
6981
{
6982
  bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6983
  unsigned int freeidx = 0;
6984
 
6985
  if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
6986
    {
6987
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6988
      Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
6989
      Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
6990
      unsigned int i;
6991
      bfd_byte *contents_end;
6992
 
6993
      hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
6994
 
6995
      elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
6996
          bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
6997
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
6998
        goto error_return;
6999
 
7000
      elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = hdr->sh_info;
7001
 
7002
      contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7003
      if (contents == NULL)
7004
        {
7005
error_return_verref:
7006
          elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
7007
          elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
7008
          goto error_return;
7009
        }
7010
      if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7011
          || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7012
        goto error_return_verref;
7013
 
7014
      if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
7015
        goto error_return_verref;
7016
 
7017
      BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
7018
                  == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
7019
      contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
7020
      everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
7021
      iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
7022
      for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
7023
        {
7024
          Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
7025
          Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
7026
          unsigned int j;
7027
 
7028
          _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
7029
 
7030
          iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
7031
 
7032
          iverneed->vn_filename =
7033
            bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7034
                                             iverneed->vn_file);
7035
          if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
7036
            goto error_return_verref;
7037
 
7038
          if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
7039
            iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
7040
          else
7041
            {
7042
              iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
7043
                  bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
7044
                              sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
7045
              if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
7046
                goto error_return_verref;
7047
            }
7048
 
7049
          if (iverneed->vn_aux
7050
              > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7051
            goto error_return_verref;
7052
 
7053
          evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7054
                      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
7055
          ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
7056
          for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
7057
            {
7058
              _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
7059
 
7060
              ivernaux->vna_nodename =
7061
                bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7062
                                                 ivernaux->vna_name);
7063
              if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
7064
                goto error_return_verref;
7065
 
7066
              if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
7067
                ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
7068
              else
7069
                ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
7070
 
7071
              if (ivernaux->vna_next
7072
                  > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
7073
                goto error_return_verref;
7074
 
7075
              evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7076
                          ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
7077
 
7078
              if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
7079
                freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
7080
            }
7081
 
7082
          if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
7083
            iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
7084
          else
7085
            iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
7086
 
7087
          if (iverneed->vn_next
7088
              > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7089
            goto error_return_verref;
7090
 
7091
          everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
7092
                      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
7093
        }
7094
 
7095
      free (contents);
7096
      contents = NULL;
7097
    }
7098
 
7099
  if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
7100
    {
7101
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7102
      Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
7103
      Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7104
      Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
7105
      Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
7106
      unsigned int i;
7107
      unsigned int maxidx;
7108
      bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
7109
 
7110
      hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
7111
 
7112
      contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7113
      if (contents == NULL)
7114
        goto error_return;
7115
      if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7116
          || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7117
        goto error_return;
7118
 
7119
      if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
7120
        goto error_return;
7121
 
7122
      BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
7123
                  >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
7124
      contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
7125
                         - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
7126
      contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
7127
                         - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
7128
 
7129
      /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
7130
         index.  Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
7131
         the maximum.  */
7132
      everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7133
      maxidx = 0;
7134
      for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
7135
        {
7136
          _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7137
 
7138
          if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
7139
            maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
7140
 
7141
          if (iverdefmem.vd_next
7142
              > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7143
            goto error_return;
7144
 
7145
          everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7146
                     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
7147
        }
7148
 
7149
      if (default_imported_symver)
7150
        {
7151
          if (freeidx > maxidx)
7152
            maxidx = ++freeidx;
7153
          else
7154
            freeidx = ++maxidx;
7155
        }
7156
      elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7157
          bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7158
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7159
        goto error_return;
7160
 
7161
      elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
7162
 
7163
      everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7164
      iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
7165
      for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
7166
        {
7167
          Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
7168
          Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7169
          unsigned int j;
7170
 
7171
          _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7172
 
7173
          if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
7174
            {
7175
error_return_verdef:
7176
              elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
7177
              elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
7178
              goto error_return;
7179
            }
7180
 
7181
          iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
7182
          memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7183
 
7184
          iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7185
 
7186
          if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
7187
            iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
7188
          else
7189
            {
7190
              iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7191
                  bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
7192
                              sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7193
              if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7194
                goto error_return_verdef;
7195
            }
7196
 
7197
          if (iverdef->vd_aux
7198
              > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7199
            goto error_return_verdef;
7200
 
7201
          everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7202
                      ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
7203
          iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7204
          for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
7205
            {
7206
              _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
7207
 
7208
              iverdaux->vda_nodename =
7209
                bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7210
                                                 iverdaux->vda_name);
7211
              if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
7212
                goto error_return_verdef;
7213
 
7214
              if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
7215
                iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
7216
              else
7217
                iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7218
 
7219
              if (iverdaux->vda_next
7220
                  > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
7221
                goto error_return_verdef;
7222
 
7223
              everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7224
                          ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
7225
            }
7226
 
7227
          if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
7228
            iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
7229
 
7230
          if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
7231
            iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
7232
          else
7233
            iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7234
 
7235
          everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7236
                     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
7237
        }
7238
 
7239
      free (contents);
7240
      contents = NULL;
7241
    }
7242
  else if (default_imported_symver)
7243
    {
7244
      if (freeidx < 3)
7245
        freeidx = 3;
7246
      else
7247
        freeidx++;
7248
 
7249
      elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7250
          bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7251
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7252
        goto error_return;
7253
 
7254
      elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
7255
    }
7256
 
7257
  /* Create a default version based on the soname.  */
7258
  if (default_imported_symver)
7259
    {
7260
      Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7261
      Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7262
 
7263
      iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];;
7264
 
7265
      iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
7266
      iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
7267
      iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
7268
      iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
7269
 
7270
      iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7271
 
7272
      iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
7273
      if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
7274
        goto error_return_verdef;
7275
      iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7276
      iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7277
          bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7278
      if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7279
        goto error_return_verdef;
7280
 
7281
      iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7282
      iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
7283
      iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7284
    }
7285
 
7286
  return TRUE;
7287
 
7288
 error_return:
7289
  if (contents != NULL)
7290
    free (contents);
7291
  return FALSE;
7292
}
7293
 
7294
asymbol *
7295
_bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
7296
{
7297
  elf_symbol_type *newsym;
7298
  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (elf_symbol_type);
7299
 
7300
  newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7301
  if (!newsym)
7302
    return NULL;
7303
  else
7304
    {
7305
      newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
7306
      return &newsym->symbol;
7307
    }
7308
}
7309
 
7310
void
7311
_bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7312
                          asymbol *symbol,
7313
                          symbol_info *ret)
7314
{
7315
  bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
7316
}
7317
 
7318
/* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol.  Most targets
7319
   use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
7320
   override it.  */
7321
 
7322
bfd_boolean
7323
_bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7324
                              const char *name)
7325
{
7326
  /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''.  */
7327
  if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
7328
    return TRUE;
7329
 
7330
  /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
7331
     DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''.  */
7332
  if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
7333
    return TRUE;
7334
 
7335
  /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
7336
     emitting DWARF debugging output.  I suspect this is actually a
7337
     small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
7338
     ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
7339
     underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets).  For ease of use,
7340
     we treat such symbols as local.  */
7341
  if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
7342
    return TRUE;
7343
 
7344
  return FALSE;
7345
}
7346
 
7347
alent *
7348
_bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7349
                     asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7350
{
7351
  abort ();
7352
  return NULL;
7353
}
7354
 
7355
bfd_boolean
7356
_bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
7357
                        enum bfd_architecture arch,
7358
                        unsigned long machine)
7359
{
7360
  /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
7361
     isn't the generic backend, fail.  */
7362
  if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
7363
      && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
7364
      && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
7365
    return FALSE;
7366
 
7367
  return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
7368
}
7369
 
7370
/* Find the function to a particular section and offset,
7371
   for error reporting.  */
7372
 
7373
static bfd_boolean
7374
elf_find_function (bfd *abfd,
7375
                   asection *section,
7376
                   asymbol **symbols,
7377
                   bfd_vma offset,
7378
                   const char **filename_ptr,
7379
                   const char **functionname_ptr)
7380
{
7381
  const char *filename;
7382
  asymbol *func, *file;
7383
  bfd_vma low_func;
7384
  asymbol **p;
7385
  /* ??? Given multiple file symbols, it is impossible to reliably
7386
     choose the right file name for global symbols.  File symbols are
7387
     local symbols, and thus all file symbols must sort before any
7388
     global symbols.  The ELF spec may be interpreted to say that a
7389
     file symbol must sort before other local symbols, but currently
7390
     ld -r doesn't do this.  So, for ld -r output, it is possible to
7391
     make a better choice of file name for local symbols by ignoring
7392
     file symbols appearing after a given local symbol.  */
7393
  enum { nothing_seen, symbol_seen, file_after_symbol_seen } state;
7394
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7395
 
7396 161 khays
  if (symbols == NULL)
7397
    return FALSE;
7398
 
7399 14 khays
  filename = NULL;
7400
  func = NULL;
7401
  file = NULL;
7402
  low_func = 0;
7403
  state = nothing_seen;
7404
 
7405
  for (p = symbols; *p != NULL; p++)
7406
    {
7407
      elf_symbol_type *q;
7408
      unsigned int type;
7409
 
7410
      q = (elf_symbol_type *) *p;
7411
 
7412
      type = ELF_ST_TYPE (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info);
7413
      switch (type)
7414
        {
7415
        case STT_FILE:
7416
          file = &q->symbol;
7417
          if (state == symbol_seen)
7418
            state = file_after_symbol_seen;
7419
          continue;
7420
        default:
7421
          if (!bed->is_function_type (type))
7422
            break;
7423
        case STT_NOTYPE:
7424
          if (bfd_get_section (&q->symbol) == section
7425
              && q->symbol.value >= low_func
7426
              && q->symbol.value <= offset)
7427
            {
7428
              func = (asymbol *) q;
7429
              low_func = q->symbol.value;
7430
              filename = NULL;
7431
              if (file != NULL
7432
                  && (ELF_ST_BIND (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STB_LOCAL
7433
                      || state != file_after_symbol_seen))
7434
                filename = bfd_asymbol_name (file);
7435
            }
7436
          break;
7437
        }
7438
      if (state == nothing_seen)
7439
        state = symbol_seen;
7440
    }
7441
 
7442
  if (func == NULL)
7443
    return FALSE;
7444
 
7445
  if (filename_ptr)
7446
    *filename_ptr = filename;
7447
  if (functionname_ptr)
7448
    *functionname_ptr = bfd_asymbol_name (func);
7449
 
7450
  return TRUE;
7451
}
7452
 
7453
/* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
7454
   for error reporting.  */
7455
 
7456
bfd_boolean
7457
_bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
7458
                            asection *section,
7459
                            asymbol **symbols,
7460
                            bfd_vma offset,
7461
                            const char **filename_ptr,
7462
                            const char **functionname_ptr,
7463
                            unsigned int *line_ptr)
7464
{
7465
  bfd_boolean found;
7466
 
7467
  if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7468
                                     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7469
                                     line_ptr))
7470
    {
7471
      if (!*functionname_ptr)
7472
        elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7473
                           *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7474
                           functionname_ptr);
7475
 
7476
      return TRUE;
7477
    }
7478
 
7479 163 khays
  if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, dwarf_debug_sections,
7480
                                     section, symbols, offset,
7481 14 khays
                                     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7482
                                     line_ptr, 0,
7483
                                     &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
7484
    {
7485
      if (!*functionname_ptr)
7486
        elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7487
                           *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7488
                           functionname_ptr);
7489
 
7490
      return TRUE;
7491
    }
7492
 
7493
  if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
7494
                                             &found, filename_ptr,
7495
                                             functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7496
                                             &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
7497
    return FALSE;
7498
  if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
7499
    return TRUE;
7500
 
7501
  if (symbols == NULL)
7502
    return FALSE;
7503
 
7504
  if (! elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7505
                           filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
7506
    return FALSE;
7507
 
7508
  *line_ptr = 0;
7509
  return TRUE;
7510
}
7511
 
7512
/* Find the line for a symbol.  */
7513
 
7514
bfd_boolean
7515
_bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
7516
                    const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
7517
{
7518
  return _bfd_dwarf2_find_line (abfd, symbols, symbol,
7519
                                filename_ptr, line_ptr, 0,
7520
                                &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7521
}
7522
 
7523
/* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
7524
   bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
7525
   each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
7526
   passed to bfd_find_nearest_line.  Currently this is only supported
7527
   for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
7528
 
7529
bfd_boolean
7530
_bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
7531
                            const char **filename_ptr,
7532
                            const char **functionname_ptr,
7533
                            unsigned int *line_ptr)
7534
{
7535
  bfd_boolean found;
7536
  found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
7537
                                         functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7538
                                         & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7539
  return found;
7540
}
7541
 
7542
int
7543
_bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7544
{
7545
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7546
  int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
7547
 
7548
  if (!info->relocatable)
7549
    {
7550
      bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
7551
 
7552
      if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
7553
        {
7554
          struct elf_segment_map *m;
7555
 
7556
          phdr_size = 0;
7557
          for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
7558
            phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
7559
 
7560
          if (phdr_size == 0)
7561
            phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
7562
        }
7563
 
7564
      elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = phdr_size;
7565
      ret += phdr_size;
7566
    }
7567
 
7568
  return ret;
7569
}
7570
 
7571
bfd_boolean
7572
_bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
7573
                               sec_ptr section,
7574
                               const void *location,
7575
                               file_ptr offset,
7576
                               bfd_size_type count)
7577
{
7578
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7579
  bfd_signed_vma pos;
7580
 
7581
  if (! abfd->output_has_begun
7582
      && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
7583
    return FALSE;
7584
 
7585
  hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
7586
  pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
7587
  if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
7588
      || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
7589
    return FALSE;
7590
 
7591
  return TRUE;
7592
}
7593
 
7594
void
7595
_bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7596
                           arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7597
                           Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7598
{
7599
  abort ();
7600
}
7601
 
7602
/* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one.  */
7603
 
7604
bfd_boolean
7605
_bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
7606
{
7607
  /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto.  */
7608
 
7609
  if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
7610
    {
7611
      bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
7612
      reloc_howto_type *howto;
7613
 
7614
      /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
7615
         equivalent ELF reloc.  */
7616
 
7617
      if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
7618
        {
7619
          switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7620
            {
7621
            case 8:
7622
              code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
7623
              break;
7624
            case 12:
7625
              code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
7626
              break;
7627
            case 16:
7628
              code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
7629
              break;
7630
            case 24:
7631
              code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
7632
              break;
7633
            case 32:
7634
              code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
7635
              break;
7636
            case 64:
7637
              code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
7638
              break;
7639
            default:
7640
              goto fail;
7641
            }
7642
 
7643
          howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7644
 
7645
          if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
7646
            {
7647
              if (howto->pcrel_offset)
7648
                areloc->addend += areloc->address;
7649
              else
7650
                areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
7651
            }
7652
        }
7653
      else
7654
        {
7655
          switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7656
            {
7657
            case 8:
7658
              code = BFD_RELOC_8;
7659
              break;
7660
            case 14:
7661
              code = BFD_RELOC_14;
7662
              break;
7663
            case 16:
7664
              code = BFD_RELOC_16;
7665
              break;
7666
            case 26:
7667
              code = BFD_RELOC_26;
7668
              break;
7669
            case 32:
7670
              code = BFD_RELOC_32;
7671
              break;
7672
            case 64:
7673
              code = BFD_RELOC_64;
7674
              break;
7675
            default:
7676
              goto fail;
7677
            }
7678
 
7679
          howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7680
        }
7681
 
7682
      if (howto)
7683
        areloc->howto = howto;
7684
      else
7685
        goto fail;
7686
    }
7687
 
7688
  return TRUE;
7689
 
7690
 fail:
7691
  (*_bfd_error_handler)
7692
    (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
7693
     abfd, areloc->howto->name);
7694
  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7695
  return FALSE;
7696
}
7697
 
7698
bfd_boolean
7699
_bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
7700
{
7701
  if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
7702
    {
7703
      if (elf_tdata (abfd) != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
7704
        _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
7705
      _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd);
7706
    }
7707
 
7708
  return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
7709
}
7710
 
7711
/* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
7712
   in the relocation's offset.  Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
7713
   range-checking to interfere.  There is nothing else to do in processing
7714
   this reloc.  */
7715
 
7716
bfd_reloc_status_type
7717
_bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
7718
  (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7719
   struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7720
   void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7721
   bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7722
{
7723
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
7724
}
7725
 
7726
/* Elf core file support.  Much of this only works on native
7727
   toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
7728
   machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
7729
   out details about the corefile.  */
7730
 
7731
#ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
7732
/* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris.  */
7733
# define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
7734
# include <sys/procfs.h>
7735
#endif
7736
 
7737
/* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
7738
   PID of the main process for non-threaded cores.  */
7739
 
7740
static int
7741
elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
7742
{
7743
  int pid;
7744
 
7745
  pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid;
7746
  if (pid == 0)
7747
    pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid;
7748
 
7749
  return pid;
7750
}
7751
 
7752
/* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
7753
   data from SECT.  Note, this function will generate a
7754
   reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
7755
   overwrite it.  */
7756
 
7757
static bfd_boolean
7758
elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
7759
{
7760
  asection *sect2;
7761
 
7762
  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
7763
    return TRUE;
7764
 
7765
  sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
7766
  if (sect2 == NULL)
7767
    return FALSE;
7768
 
7769
  sect2->size = sect->size;
7770
  sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
7771
  sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
7772
  return TRUE;
7773
}
7774
 
7775
/* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS.  This
7776
   actually creates up to two pseudosections:
7777
   - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
7778
     such a section already exists.
7779
   - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
7780
     PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
7781
   Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
7782
bfd_boolean
7783
_bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7784
                                 char *name,
7785
                                 size_t size,
7786
                                 ufile_ptr filepos)
7787
{
7788
  char buf[100];
7789
  char *threaded_name;
7790
  size_t len;
7791
  asection *sect;
7792
 
7793
  /* Build the section name.  */
7794
 
7795
  sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
7796
  len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7797
  threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7798
  if (threaded_name == NULL)
7799
    return FALSE;
7800
  memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
7801
 
7802
  sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
7803
                                             SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7804
  if (sect == NULL)
7805
    return FALSE;
7806
  sect->size = size;
7807
  sect->filepos = filepos;
7808
  sect->alignment_power = 2;
7809
 
7810
  return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
7811
}
7812
 
7813
/* prstatus_t exists on:
7814
     solaris 2.5+
7815
     linux 2.[01] + glibc
7816
     unixware 4.2
7817
*/
7818
 
7819
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
7820
 
7821
static bfd_boolean
7822
elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7823
{
7824
  size_t size;
7825
  int offset;
7826
 
7827
  if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
7828
    {
7829
      prstatus_t prstat;
7830
 
7831
      size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
7832
      offset   = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
7833
      memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
7834
 
7835
      /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
7836
         has already been set by another thread.  */
7837
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
7838
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
7839
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid == 0)
7840
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
7841
 
7842
      /* pr_who exists on:
7843
         solaris 2.5+
7844
         unixware 4.2
7845
         pr_who doesn't exist on:
7846
         linux 2.[01]
7847
         */
7848
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
7849
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
7850
#else
7851
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
7852
#endif
7853
    }
7854
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
7855
  else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
7856
    {
7857
      /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
7858
      prstatus32_t prstat;
7859
 
7860
      size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
7861
      offset   = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
7862
      memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
7863
 
7864
      /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
7865
         has already been set by another thread.  */
7866
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
7867
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
7868
      if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid == 0)
7869
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
7870
 
7871
      /* pr_who exists on:
7872
         solaris 2.5+
7873
         unixware 4.2
7874
         pr_who doesn't exist on:
7875
         linux 2.[01]
7876
         */
7877
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
7878
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
7879
#else
7880
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
7881
#endif
7882
    }
7883
#endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
7884
  else
7885
    {
7886
      /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
7887
         note size (ie. data object type).  */
7888
      return TRUE;
7889
    }
7890
 
7891
  /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section.  */
7892
  return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
7893
                                          size, note->descpos + offset);
7894
}
7895
#endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
7896
 
7897
/* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE.  */
7898
static bfd_boolean
7899
elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7900
                                 char *name,
7901
                                 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7902
{
7903
  return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
7904
                                          note->descsz, note->descpos);
7905
}
7906
 
7907
/* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
7908
   but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
7909
   data structure apart.  */
7910
 
7911
static bfd_boolean
7912
elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7913
{
7914
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
7915
}
7916
 
7917
/* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
7918
   type of NT_PRXFPREG.  Just include the whole note's contents
7919
   literally.  */
7920
 
7921
static bfd_boolean
7922
elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7923
{
7924
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
7925
}
7926
 
7927
/* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
7928
   with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE.  Just include the whole note's
7929
   contents literally.  */
7930
 
7931
static bfd_boolean
7932
elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7933
{
7934
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
7935
}
7936
 
7937
static bfd_boolean
7938
elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7939
{
7940
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
7941
}
7942
 
7943
static bfd_boolean
7944
elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7945
{
7946
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
7947
}
7948
 
7949
static bfd_boolean
7950
elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7951
{
7952
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
7953
}
7954
 
7955
static bfd_boolean
7956
elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7957
{
7958
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
7959
}
7960
 
7961
static bfd_boolean
7962
elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7963
{
7964
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
7965
}
7966
 
7967
static bfd_boolean
7968
elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7969
{
7970
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
7971
}
7972
 
7973
static bfd_boolean
7974
elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7975
{
7976
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
7977
}
7978
 
7979
static bfd_boolean
7980
elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7981
{
7982
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
7983
}
7984
 
7985 161 khays
static bfd_boolean
7986
elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7987
{
7988
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
7989
}
7990
 
7991 14 khays
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
7992
typedef prpsinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
7993
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T)         /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
7994
typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
7995
#endif
7996
#endif
7997
 
7998
#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
7999
typedef psinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
8000
#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)           /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8001
typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8002
#endif
8003
#endif
8004
 
8005
/* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
8006
   most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
8007
   the copy will always have a terminating '\0'.  */
8008
 
8009
char *
8010
_bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
8011
{
8012
  char *dups;
8013
  char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
8014
  size_t len;
8015
 
8016
  if (end == NULL)
8017
    len = max;
8018
  else
8019
    len = end - start;
8020
 
8021
  dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
8022
  if (dups == NULL)
8023
    return NULL;
8024
 
8025
  memcpy (dups, start, len);
8026
  dups[len] = '\0';
8027
 
8028
  return dups;
8029
}
8030
 
8031
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8032
static bfd_boolean
8033
elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8034
{
8035
  if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
8036
    {
8037
      elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
8038
 
8039
      memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8040
 
8041
#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
8042
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8043
#endif
8044
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
8045
        = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8046
                                sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8047
 
8048
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8049
        = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8050
                                sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8051
    }
8052
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8053
  else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
8054
    {
8055
      /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8056
      elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
8057
 
8058
      memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8059
 
8060
#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
8061
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8062
#endif
8063
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
8064
        = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8065
                                sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8066
 
8067
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8068
        = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8069
                                sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8070
    }
8071
#endif
8072
 
8073
  else
8074
    {
8075
      /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8076
         note size (ie. data object type).  */
8077
      return TRUE;
8078
    }
8079
 
8080
  /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
8081
     onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
8082
     implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
8083
 
8084
  {
8085
    char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
8086
    int n = strlen (command);
8087
 
8088
    if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
8089
      command[n - 1] = '\0';
8090
  }
8091
 
8092
  return TRUE;
8093
}
8094
#endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
8095
 
8096
#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8097
static bfd_boolean
8098
elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8099
{
8100
  if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
8101
#if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
8102
      || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
8103
#endif
8104
      )
8105
    {
8106
      pstatus_t pstat;
8107
 
8108
      memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8109
 
8110
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8111
    }
8112
#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8113
  else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
8114
    {
8115
      /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8116
      pstatus32_t pstat;
8117
 
8118
      memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8119
 
8120
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8121
    }
8122
#endif
8123
  /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
8124
     lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
8125
     NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably.  */
8126
 
8127
  return TRUE;
8128
}
8129
#endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
8130
 
8131
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8132
static bfd_boolean
8133
elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8134
{
8135
  lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8136
  char buf[100];
8137
  char *name;
8138
  size_t len;
8139
  asection *sect;
8140
 
8141
  if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
8142
#if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
8143
      && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
8144
#endif
8145
      )
8146
    return TRUE;
8147
 
8148
  memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
8149
 
8150
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
8151
  /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
8152
     another thread.  */
8153
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
8154
    elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
8155
 
8156
  /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
8157
 
8158
  sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8159
  len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8160
  name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8161
  if (name == NULL)
8162
    return FALSE;
8163
  memcpy (name, buf, len);
8164
 
8165
  sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8166
  if (sect == NULL)
8167
    return FALSE;
8168
 
8169
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8170
  sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8171
  sect->filepos = note->descpos
8172
    + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8173
#endif
8174
 
8175
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8176
  sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
8177
  sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
8178
#endif
8179
 
8180
  sect->alignment_power = 2;
8181
 
8182
  if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8183
    return FALSE;
8184
 
8185
  /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
8186
 
8187
  sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8188
  len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8189
  name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8190
  if (name == NULL)
8191
    return FALSE;
8192
  memcpy (name, buf, len);
8193
 
8194
  sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8195
  if (sect == NULL)
8196
    return FALSE;
8197
 
8198
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8199
  sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8200
  sect->filepos = note->descpos
8201
    + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8202
#endif
8203
 
8204
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
8205
  sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
8206
  sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
8207
#endif
8208
 
8209
  sect->alignment_power = 2;
8210
 
8211
  return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
8212
}
8213
#endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
8214
 
8215
static bfd_boolean
8216
elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8217
{
8218
  char buf[30];
8219
  char *name;
8220
  size_t len;
8221
  asection *sect;
8222
  int type;
8223
  int is_active_thread;
8224
  bfd_vma base_addr;
8225
 
8226
  if (note->descsz < 728)
8227
    return TRUE;
8228
 
8229
  if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
8230
    return TRUE;
8231
 
8232
  type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
8233
 
8234
  switch (type)
8235
    {
8236
    case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
8237
      /* FIXME: need to add ->core_command.  */
8238
      /* process_info.pid */
8239
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8240
      /* process_info.signal */
8241
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
8242
      break;
8243
 
8244
    case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
8245
      /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
8246
      /* thread_info.tid */
8247
      sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
8248
 
8249
      len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8250
      name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8251
      if (name == NULL)
8252
        return FALSE;
8253
 
8254
      memcpy (name, buf, len);
8255
 
8256
      sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8257
      if (sect == NULL)
8258
        return FALSE;
8259
 
8260
      /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8261
      sect->size = 716;
8262
      /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8263
      sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
8264
      sect->alignment_power = 2;
8265
 
8266
      /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
8267
      is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8268
 
8269
      if (is_active_thread)
8270
        if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8271
          return FALSE;
8272
      break;
8273
 
8274
    case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
8275
      /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section.  */
8276
      /* module_info.base_address */
8277
      base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
8278
      sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
8279
 
8280
      len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8281
      name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8282
      if (name == NULL)
8283
        return FALSE;
8284
 
8285
      memcpy (name, buf, len);
8286
 
8287
      sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8288
 
8289
      if (sect == NULL)
8290
        return FALSE;
8291
 
8292
      sect->size = note->descsz;
8293
      sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8294
      sect->alignment_power = 2;
8295
      break;
8296
 
8297
    default:
8298
      return TRUE;
8299
    }
8300
 
8301
  return TRUE;
8302
}
8303
 
8304
static bfd_boolean
8305
elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8306
{
8307
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8308
 
8309
  switch (note->type)
8310
    {
8311
    default:
8312
      return TRUE;
8313
 
8314
    case NT_PRSTATUS:
8315
      if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
8316
        if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
8317
          return TRUE;
8318
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8319
      return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
8320
#else
8321
      return TRUE;
8322
#endif
8323
 
8324
#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8325
    case NT_PSTATUS:
8326
      return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
8327
#endif
8328
 
8329
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8330
    case NT_LWPSTATUS:
8331
      return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
8332
#endif
8333
 
8334
    case NT_FPREGSET:           /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
8335
      return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
8336
 
8337
    case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
8338
      return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
8339
 
8340
    case NT_PRXFPREG:           /* Linux SSE extension */
8341
      if (note->namesz == 6
8342
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8343
        return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
8344
      else
8345
        return TRUE;
8346
 
8347
    case NT_X86_XSTATE:         /* Linux XSAVE extension */
8348
      if (note->namesz == 6
8349
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8350
        return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
8351
      else
8352
        return TRUE;
8353
 
8354
    case NT_PPC_VMX:
8355
      if (note->namesz == 6
8356
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8357
        return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
8358
      else
8359
        return TRUE;
8360
 
8361
    case NT_PPC_VSX:
8362
      if (note->namesz == 6
8363
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8364
        return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
8365
      else
8366
        return TRUE;
8367
 
8368
    case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
8369
      if (note->namesz == 6
8370
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8371
        return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
8372
      else
8373
        return TRUE;
8374
 
8375
    case NT_S390_TIMER:
8376
      if (note->namesz == 6
8377
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8378
        return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
8379
      else
8380
        return TRUE;
8381
 
8382
    case NT_S390_TODCMP:
8383
      if (note->namesz == 6
8384
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8385
        return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
8386
      else
8387
        return TRUE;
8388
 
8389
    case NT_S390_TODPREG:
8390
      if (note->namesz == 6
8391
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8392
        return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
8393
      else
8394
        return TRUE;
8395
 
8396
    case NT_S390_CTRS:
8397
      if (note->namesz == 6
8398
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8399
        return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
8400
      else
8401
        return TRUE;
8402
 
8403
    case NT_S390_PREFIX:
8404
      if (note->namesz == 6
8405
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8406
        return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
8407
      else
8408
        return TRUE;
8409
 
8410 161 khays
    case NT_ARM_VFP:
8411
      if (note->namesz == 6
8412
          && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8413
        return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
8414
      else
8415
        return TRUE;
8416
 
8417 14 khays
    case NT_PRPSINFO:
8418
    case NT_PSINFO:
8419
      if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
8420
        if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
8421
          return TRUE;
8422
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8423
      return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
8424
#else
8425
      return TRUE;
8426
#endif
8427
 
8428
    case NT_AUXV:
8429
      {
8430
        asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
8431
                                                             SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8432
 
8433
        if (sect == NULL)
8434
          return FALSE;
8435
        sect->size = note->descsz;
8436
        sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8437
        sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8438
 
8439
        return TRUE;
8440
      }
8441
    }
8442
}
8443
 
8444
static bfd_boolean
8445
elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8446
{
8447
  elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id_size = note->descsz;
8448
  elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, note->descsz);
8449
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id == NULL)
8450
    return FALSE;
8451
 
8452
  memcpy (elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id, note->descdata, note->descsz);
8453
 
8454
  return TRUE;
8455
}
8456
 
8457
static bfd_boolean
8458
elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8459
{
8460
  switch (note->type)
8461
    {
8462
    default:
8463
      return TRUE;
8464
 
8465
    case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
8466
      return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
8467
    }
8468
}
8469
 
8470
static bfd_boolean
8471
elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8472
{
8473
  struct sdt_note *cur =
8474
    (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
8475
                                   + note->descsz);
8476
 
8477
  cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
8478
  cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
8479
  memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
8480
 
8481
  elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
8482
 
8483
  return TRUE;
8484
}
8485
 
8486
static bfd_boolean
8487
elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8488
{
8489
  switch (note->type)
8490
    {
8491
    case NT_STAPSDT:
8492
      return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
8493
 
8494
    default:
8495
      return TRUE;
8496
    }
8497
}
8498
 
8499
static bfd_boolean
8500
elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
8501
{
8502
  char *cp;
8503
 
8504
  cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
8505
  if (cp != NULL)
8506
    {
8507
      *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
8508
      return TRUE;
8509
    }
8510
  return FALSE;
8511
}
8512
 
8513
static bfd_boolean
8514
elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8515
{
8516
  /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8517
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
8518
    = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8519
 
8520
  /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
8521
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
8522
    = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
8523
 
8524
  /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8525
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8526
    = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
8527
 
8528
  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
8529
                                          note);
8530
}
8531
 
8532
static bfd_boolean
8533
elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8534
{
8535
  int lwp;
8536
 
8537
  if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
8538
    elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwp;
8539
 
8540
  if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
8541
    {
8542
      /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo".  Note that we expect to
8543
         find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
8544
         since the kernel writes this note out first when it
8545
         creates a core file.  */
8546
 
8547
      return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8548
    }
8549
 
8550
  /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
8551
     defined for NetBSD core files.  If the note type is less
8552
     than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
8553
     understand it.  */
8554
 
8555
  if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
8556
    return TRUE;
8557
 
8558
 
8559
  switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
8560
    {
8561
      /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
8562
         PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2.  */
8563
 
8564
    case bfd_arch_alpha:
8565
    case bfd_arch_sparc:
8566
      switch (note->type)
8567
        {
8568
        case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
8569
          return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8570
 
8571
        case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
8572
          return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8573
 
8574
        default:
8575
          return TRUE;
8576
        }
8577
 
8578
      /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
8579
         PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3.  */
8580
 
8581
    default:
8582
      switch (note->type)
8583
        {
8584
        case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
8585
          return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8586
 
8587
        case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
8588
          return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8589
 
8590
        default:
8591
          return TRUE;
8592
        }
8593
    }
8594
    /* NOTREACHED */
8595
}
8596
 
8597
static bfd_boolean
8598
elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8599
{
8600
  /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8601
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
8602
    = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8603
 
8604
  /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
8605
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
8606
    = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
8607
 
8608
  /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8609
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8610
    = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
8611
 
8612
  return TRUE;
8613
}
8614
 
8615
static bfd_boolean
8616
elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8617
{
8618
  if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
8619
    return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8620
 
8621
  if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
8622
    return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8623
 
8624
  if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
8625
    return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8626
 
8627
  if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
8628
    return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
8629
 
8630
  if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
8631
    {
8632
      asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
8633
                                                           SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8634
 
8635
      if (sect == NULL)
8636
        return FALSE;
8637
      sect->size = note->descsz;
8638
      sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8639
      sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8640
 
8641
      return TRUE;
8642
    }
8643
 
8644
  if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
8645
    {
8646
      asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
8647
                                                           SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8648
 
8649
      if (sect == NULL)
8650
        return FALSE;
8651
      sect->size = note->descsz;
8652
      sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8653
      sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8654
 
8655
      return TRUE;
8656
    }
8657
 
8658
  return TRUE;
8659
}
8660
 
8661
static bfd_boolean
8662
elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
8663
{
8664
  void *ddata = note->descdata;
8665
  char buf[100];
8666
  char *name;
8667
  asection *sect;
8668
  short sig;
8669
  unsigned flags;
8670
 
8671
  /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0.  */
8672
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
8673
 
8674
  /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4.  Pass it back.  */
8675
  *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
8676
 
8677
  /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8.  */
8678
  flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
8679
 
8680
  /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14.  */
8681
  if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
8682
    {
8683
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = sig;
8684
      elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
8685
    }
8686
 
8687
  /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80.  Some cores
8688
     do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
8689
     thread just in case.  */
8690
  if (flags & 0x00000080)
8691
    elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
8692
 
8693
  /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section.  */
8694
  sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
8695
 
8696
  name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8697
  if (name == NULL)
8698
    return FALSE;
8699
  strcpy (name, buf);
8700
 
8701
  sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8702
  if (sect == NULL)
8703
    return FALSE;
8704
 
8705
  sect->size            = note->descsz;
8706
  sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
8707
  sect->alignment_power = 2;
8708
 
8709
  return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
8710
}
8711
 
8712
static bfd_boolean
8713
elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
8714
                       Elf_Internal_Note *note,
8715
                       long tid,
8716
                       char *base)
8717
{
8718
  char buf[100];
8719
  char *name;
8720
  asection *sect;
8721
 
8722
  /* Make a "(base)/%d" section.  */
8723
  sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
8724
 
8725
  name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8726
  if (name == NULL)
8727
    return FALSE;
8728
  strcpy (name, buf);
8729
 
8730
  sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8731
  if (sect == NULL)
8732
    return FALSE;
8733
 
8734
  sect->size            = note->descsz;
8735
  sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
8736
  sect->alignment_power = 2;
8737
 
8738
  /* This is the current thread.  */
8739
  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid == tid)
8740
    return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
8741
 
8742
  return TRUE;
8743
}
8744
 
8745
#define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO       7
8746
#define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS     8
8747
#define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG       9
8748
#define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG      10
8749
 
8750
static bfd_boolean
8751
elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8752
{
8753
  /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it.  Store the
8754
     tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
8755
     function.  */
8756
  static long tid = 1;
8757
 
8758
  switch (note->type)
8759
    {
8760
    case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
8761
      return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
8762
    case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
8763
      return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
8764
    case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
8765
      return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
8766
    case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
8767
      return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
8768
    default:
8769
      return TRUE;
8770
    }
8771
}
8772
 
8773
static bfd_boolean
8774
elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8775
{
8776
  char *name;
8777
  asection *sect;
8778
  size_t len;
8779
 
8780
  /* Use note name as section name.  */
8781
  len = note->namesz;
8782
  name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8783
  if (name == NULL)
8784
    return FALSE;
8785
  memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
8786
  name[len - 1] = '\0';
8787
 
8788
  sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8789
  if (sect == NULL)
8790
    return FALSE;
8791
 
8792
  sect->size            = note->descsz;
8793
  sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
8794
  sect->alignment_power = 1;
8795
 
8796
  return TRUE;
8797
}
8798
 
8799
/* Function: elfcore_write_note
8800
 
8801
   Inputs:
8802
     buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
8803
     name of note
8804
     type of note
8805
     data for note
8806
     size of data for note
8807
 
8808
   Writes note to end of buffer.  ELF64 notes are written exactly as
8809
   for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
8810
   that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
8811
   8-byte alignment.  Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
8812
 
8813
   Return:
8814
   Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated.  */
8815
 
8816
char *
8817
elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
8818
                    char *buf,
8819
                    int *bufsiz,
8820
                    const char *name,
8821
                    int type,
8822
                    const void *input,
8823
                    int size)
8824
{
8825
  Elf_External_Note *xnp;
8826
  size_t namesz;
8827
  size_t newspace;
8828
  char *dest;
8829
 
8830
  namesz = 0;
8831
  if (name != NULL)
8832
    namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
8833
 
8834
  newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
8835
 
8836
  buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
8837
  if (buf == NULL)
8838
    return buf;
8839
  dest = buf + *bufsiz;
8840
  *bufsiz += newspace;
8841
  xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
8842
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
8843
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
8844
  H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
8845
  dest = xnp->name;
8846
  if (name != NULL)
8847
    {
8848
      memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
8849
      dest += namesz;
8850
      while (namesz & 3)
8851
        {
8852
          *dest++ = '\0';
8853
          ++namesz;
8854
        }
8855
    }
8856
  memcpy (dest, input, size);
8857
  dest += size;
8858
  while (size & 3)
8859
    {
8860
      *dest++ = '\0';
8861
      ++size;
8862
    }
8863
  return buf;
8864
}
8865
 
8866
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8867
char *
8868
elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd  *abfd,
8869
                        char *buf,
8870
                        int  *bufsiz,
8871
                        const char *fname,
8872
                        const char *psargs)
8873
{
8874
  const char *note_name = "CORE";
8875
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8876
 
8877
  if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
8878
    {
8879
      char *ret;
8880
      ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8881
                                                 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
8882
      if (ret != NULL)
8883
        return ret;
8884
    }
8885
 
8886
#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8887
  if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8888
    {
8889
#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8890
      psinfo32_t data;
8891
      int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
8892
#else
8893
      prpsinfo32_t data;
8894
      int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
8895
#endif
8896
 
8897
      memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
8898
      strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
8899
      strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
8900
      return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8901
                                 note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
8902
    }
8903
  else
8904
#endif
8905
    {
8906
#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8907
      psinfo_t data;
8908
      int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
8909
#else
8910
      prpsinfo_t data;
8911
      int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
8912
#endif
8913
 
8914
      memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
8915
      strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
8916
      strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
8917
      return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8918
                                 note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
8919
    }
8920
}
8921
#endif  /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
8922
 
8923
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8924
char *
8925
elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
8926
                        char *buf,
8927
                        int *bufsiz,
8928
                        long pid,
8929
                        int cursig,
8930
                        const void *gregs)
8931
{
8932
  const char *note_name = "CORE";
8933
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8934
 
8935
  if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
8936
    {
8937
      char *ret;
8938
      ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8939
                                                 NT_PRSTATUS,
8940
                                                 pid, cursig, gregs);
8941
      if (ret != NULL)
8942
        return ret;
8943
    }
8944
 
8945
#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
8946
  if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8947
    {
8948
      prstatus32_t prstat;
8949
 
8950
      memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
8951
      prstat.pr_pid = pid;
8952
      prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8953
      memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
8954
      return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8955
                                 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
8956
    }
8957
  else
8958
#endif
8959
    {
8960
      prstatus_t prstat;
8961
 
8962
      memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
8963
      prstat.pr_pid = pid;
8964
      prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8965
      memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
8966
      return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8967
                                 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
8968
    }
8969
}
8970
#endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
8971
 
8972
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8973
char *
8974
elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
8975
                         char *buf,
8976
                         int *bufsiz,
8977
                         long pid,
8978
                         int cursig,
8979
                         const void *gregs)
8980
{
8981
  lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8982
  const char *note_name = "CORE";
8983
 
8984
  memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
8985
  lwpstat.pr_lwpid  = pid >> 16;
8986
  lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8987
#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8988
  memcpy (lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
8989
#elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8990
#if !defined(gregs)
8991
  memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
8992
          gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
8993
#else
8994
  memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
8995
          gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
8996
#endif
8997
#endif
8998
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8999
                             NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
9000
}
9001
#endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
9002
 
9003
#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9004
char *
9005
elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
9006
                       char *buf,
9007
                       int *bufsiz,
9008
                       long pid,
9009
                       int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9010
                       const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9011
{
9012
  const char *note_name = "CORE";
9013
#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9014
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9015
 
9016
  if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9017
    {
9018
      pstatus32_t pstat;
9019
 
9020
      memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9021
      pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9022
      buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9023
                                NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9024
      return buf;
9025
    }
9026
  else
9027
#endif
9028
    {
9029
      pstatus_t pstat;
9030
 
9031
      memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9032
      pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9033
      buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9034
                                NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9035
      return buf;
9036
    }
9037
}
9038
#endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
9039
 
9040
char *
9041
elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9042
                       char *buf,
9043
                       int *bufsiz,
9044
                       const void *fpregs,
9045
                       int size)
9046
{
9047
  const char *note_name = "CORE";
9048
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9049
                             note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
9050
}
9051
 
9052
char *
9053
elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9054
                        char *buf,
9055
                        int *bufsiz,
9056
                        const void *xfpregs,
9057
                        int size)
9058
{
9059
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9060
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9061
                             note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
9062
}
9063
 
9064
char *
9065
elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9066
                         const void *xfpregs, int size)
9067
{
9068
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9069
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9070
                             note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
9071
}
9072
 
9073
char *
9074
elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
9075
                       char *buf,
9076
                       int *bufsiz,
9077
                       const void *ppc_vmx,
9078
                       int size)
9079
{
9080
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9081
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9082
                             note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
9083
}
9084
 
9085
char *
9086
elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
9087
                       char *buf,
9088
                       int *bufsiz,
9089
                       const void *ppc_vsx,
9090
                       int size)
9091
{
9092
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9093
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9094
                             note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
9095
}
9096
 
9097
static char *
9098
elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
9099
                              char *buf,
9100
                              int *bufsiz,
9101
                              const void *s390_high_gprs,
9102
                              int size)
9103
{
9104
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9105
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9106
                             note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
9107
                             s390_high_gprs, size);
9108
}
9109
 
9110
char *
9111
elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
9112
                          char *buf,
9113
                          int *bufsiz,
9114
                          const void *s390_timer,
9115
                          int size)
9116
{
9117
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9118
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9119
                             note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
9120
}
9121
 
9122
char *
9123
elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
9124
                           char *buf,
9125
                           int *bufsiz,
9126
                           const void *s390_todcmp,
9127
                           int size)
9128
{
9129
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9130
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9131
                             note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
9132
}
9133
 
9134
char *
9135
elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
9136
                            char *buf,
9137
                            int *bufsiz,
9138
                            const void *s390_todpreg,
9139
                            int size)
9140
{
9141
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9142
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9143
                             note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
9144
}
9145
 
9146
char *
9147
elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
9148
                         char *buf,
9149
                         int *bufsiz,
9150
                         const void *s390_ctrs,
9151
                         int size)
9152
{
9153
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9154
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9155
                             note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
9156
}
9157
 
9158
char *
9159
elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
9160
                           char *buf,
9161
                           int *bufsiz,
9162
                           const void *s390_prefix,
9163
                           int size)
9164
{
9165
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9166
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9167
                             note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
9168
}
9169
 
9170
char *
9171 161 khays
elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
9172
                       char *buf,
9173
                       int *bufsiz,
9174
                       const void *arm_vfp,
9175
                       int size)
9176
{
9177
  char *note_name = "LINUX";
9178
  return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9179
                             note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
9180
}
9181
 
9182
char *
9183 14 khays
elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
9184
                             char *buf,
9185
                             int *bufsiz,
9186
                             const char *section,
9187
                             const void *data,
9188
                             int size)
9189
{
9190
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
9191
    return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9192
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
9193
    return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9194
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
9195
    return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9196
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
9197
    return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9198
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
9199
    return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9200
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
9201
    return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9202
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
9203
    return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9204
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
9205
    return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9206
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
9207
    return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9208
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
9209
    return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9210
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
9211
    return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9212 161 khays
  if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
9213
    return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9214 14 khays
  return NULL;
9215
}
9216
 
9217
static bfd_boolean
9218
elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
9219
{
9220
  char *p;
9221
 
9222
  p = buf;
9223
  while (p < buf + size)
9224
    {
9225
      /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption.  */
9226
      Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
9227
      Elf_Internal_Note in;
9228
 
9229
      if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
9230
        return FALSE;
9231
 
9232
      in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
9233
 
9234
      in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
9235
      in.namedata = xnp->name;
9236
      if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
9237
        return FALSE;
9238
 
9239
      in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
9240
      in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
9241
      in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
9242
      if (in.descsz != 0
9243
          && (in.descdata >= buf + size
9244
              || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
9245
        return FALSE;
9246
 
9247
      switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
9248
        {
9249
        default:
9250
          return TRUE;
9251
 
9252
        case bfd_core:
9253
          if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "NetBSD-CORE"))
9254
            {
9255
              if (! elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (abfd, &in))
9256
                return FALSE;
9257
            }
9258
          else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "OpenBSD"))
9259
            {
9260
              if (! elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (abfd, &in))
9261
                return FALSE;
9262
            }
9263
          else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "QNX"))
9264
            {
9265
              if (! elfcore_grok_nto_note (abfd, &in))
9266
                return FALSE;
9267
            }
9268
          else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "SPU/"))
9269
            {
9270
              if (! elfcore_grok_spu_note (abfd, &in))
9271
                return FALSE;
9272
            }
9273
          else
9274
            {
9275
              if (! elfcore_grok_note (abfd, &in))
9276
                return FALSE;
9277
            }
9278
          break;
9279
 
9280
        case bfd_object:
9281
          if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
9282
            {
9283
              if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
9284
                return FALSE;
9285
            }
9286
          else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
9287
                   && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
9288
            {
9289
              if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
9290
                return FALSE;
9291
            }
9292
          break;
9293
        }
9294
 
9295
      p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
9296
    }
9297
 
9298
  return TRUE;
9299
}
9300
 
9301
static bfd_boolean
9302
elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
9303
{
9304
  char *buf;
9305
 
9306
  if (size <= 0)
9307
    return TRUE;
9308
 
9309
  if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
9310
    return FALSE;
9311
 
9312
  buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size);
9313
  if (buf == NULL)
9314
    return FALSE;
9315
 
9316
  if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
9317
      || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
9318
    {
9319
      free (buf);
9320
      return FALSE;
9321
    }
9322
 
9323
  free (buf);
9324
  return TRUE;
9325
}
9326
 
9327
/* Providing external access to the ELF program header table.  */
9328
 
9329
/* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
9330
   copy of ABFD's program header table entries.  Return -1 if an error
9331
   occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
9332
 
9333
long
9334
bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
9335
{
9336
  if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9337
    {
9338
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
9339
      return -1;
9340
    }
9341
 
9342
  return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
9343
}
9344
 
9345
/* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS.  The entries
9346
   will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
9347
   defined in include/elf/internal.h.  To find out how large the
9348
   buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
9349
 
9350
   Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
9351
   error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
9352
 
9353
int
9354
bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
9355
{
9356
  int num_phdrs;
9357
 
9358
  if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9359
    {
9360
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
9361
      return -1;
9362
    }
9363
 
9364
  num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
9365
  memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
9366
          num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
9367
 
9368
  return num_phdrs;
9369
}
9370
 
9371
enum elf_reloc_type_class
9372
_bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9373
{
9374
  return reloc_class_normal;
9375
}
9376
 
9377
/* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
9378
   relocation against a local symbol.  */
9379
 
9380
bfd_vma
9381
_bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
9382
                         Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
9383
                         asection **psec,
9384
                         Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9385
{
9386
  asection *sec = *psec;
9387
  bfd_vma relocation;
9388
 
9389
  relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
9390
                + sec->output_offset
9391
                + sym->st_value);
9392
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
9393
      && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
9394
      && sec->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
9395
    {
9396
      rel->r_addend =
9397
        _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
9398
                                    elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9399
                                    sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
9400
      if (sec != *psec)
9401
        {
9402
          /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
9403
             marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
9404
             SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
9405
             other SEC_MERGE section.  In this case, we need to leave
9406
             some info around for --emit-relocs.  */
9407
          if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
9408
            sec->kept_section = *psec;
9409
          sec = *psec;
9410
        }
9411
      rel->r_addend -= relocation;
9412
      rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9413
    }
9414
  return relocation;
9415
}
9416
 
9417
bfd_vma
9418
_bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
9419
                        Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
9420
                        asection **psec,
9421
                        bfd_vma addend)
9422
{
9423
  asection *sec = *psec;
9424
 
9425
  if (sec->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
9426
    return sym->st_value + addend;
9427
 
9428
  return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
9429
                                     elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9430
                                     sym->st_value + addend);
9431
}
9432
 
9433
bfd_vma
9434
_bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
9435
                         struct bfd_link_info *info,
9436
                         asection *sec,
9437
                         bfd_vma offset)
9438
{
9439
  switch (sec->sec_info_type)
9440
    {
9441
    case ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
9442
      return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9443
                                       offset);
9444
    case ELF_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
9445
      return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
9446
    default:
9447
      if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
9448
        {
9449
          const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9450
          bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
9451
          offset = sec->size - offset - address_size;
9452
        }
9453
      return offset;
9454
    }
9455
}
9456
 
9457
/* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr.  Rather than opening a file,
9458
   reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
9459
   based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
9460
   points to.  If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
9461
   between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
9462
   file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
9463
 
9464
   The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
9465
   remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
9466
   should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure.  TEMPL must
9467
   be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
9468
   the remote memory.  */
9469
 
9470
bfd *
9471
bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
9472
  (bfd *templ,
9473
   bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
9474
   bfd_vma *loadbasep,
9475
   int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, int))
9476
{
9477
  return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
9478
    (templ, ehdr_vma, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
9479
}
9480
 
9481
long
9482
_bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
9483
                               long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9484
                               asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9485
                               long dynsymcount,
9486
                               asymbol **dynsyms,
9487
                               asymbol **ret)
9488
{
9489
  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9490
  asection *relplt;
9491
  asymbol *s;
9492
  const char *relplt_name;
9493
  bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
9494
  arelent *p;
9495
  long count, i, n;
9496
  size_t size;
9497
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9498
  char *names;
9499
  asection *plt;
9500
 
9501
  *ret = NULL;
9502
 
9503
  if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
9504
    return 0;
9505
 
9506
  if (dynsymcount <= 0)
9507
    return 0;
9508
 
9509
  if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
9510
    return 0;
9511
 
9512
  relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
9513
  if (relplt_name == NULL)
9514
    relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
9515
  relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
9516
  if (relplt == NULL)
9517
    return 0;
9518
 
9519
  hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
9520
  if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
9521
      || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
9522
    return 0;
9523
 
9524
  plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
9525
  if (plt == NULL)
9526
    return 0;
9527
 
9528
  slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
9529
  if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
9530
    return -1;
9531
 
9532
  count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
9533
  size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
9534
  p = relplt->relocation;
9535
  for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
9536
    {
9537
      size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
9538
      if (p->addend != 0)
9539
        {
9540
#ifdef BFD64
9541
          size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
9542
#else
9543
          size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
9544
#endif
9545
        }
9546
    }
9547
 
9548
  s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
9549
  if (s == NULL)
9550
    return -1;
9551
 
9552
  names = (char *) (s + count);
9553
  p = relplt->relocation;
9554
  n = 0;
9555
  for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
9556
    {
9557
      size_t len;
9558
      bfd_vma addr;
9559
 
9560
      addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
9561
      if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
9562
        continue;
9563
 
9564
      *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
9565
      /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
9566
         we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
9567
      if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
9568
        s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
9569
      s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
9570
      s->section = plt;
9571
      s->value = addr - plt->vma;
9572
      s->name = names;
9573
      s->udata.p = NULL;
9574
      len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
9575
      memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
9576
      names += len;
9577
      if (p->addend != 0)
9578
        {
9579
          char buf[30], *a;
9580
 
9581
          memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
9582
          names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
9583
          bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
9584
          for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
9585
            ;
9586
          len = strlen (a);
9587
          memcpy (names, a, len);
9588
          names += len;
9589
        }
9590
      memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
9591
      names += sizeof ("@plt");
9592
      ++s, ++n;
9593
    }
9594
 
9595
  return n;
9596
}
9597
 
9598
/* It is only used by x86-64 so far.  */
9599
asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
9600
  = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
9601
                      SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
9602
 
9603
void
9604
_bfd_elf_set_osabi (bfd * abfd,
9605
                    struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9606
{
9607
  Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp;  /* ELF file header, internal form.  */
9608
 
9609
  i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
9610
 
9611
  i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
9612
 
9613
  /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
9614 161 khays
     osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
9615 14 khays
     the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding.  */
9616
  if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
9617
      && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
9618 161 khays
    i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
9619 14 khays
}
9620
 
9621
 
9622
/* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
9623
   This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
9624
   most targets.  It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
9625
 
9626
bfd_boolean
9627
_bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
9628
{
9629
  return (type == STT_FUNC
9630
          || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
9631
}

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.